1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ 2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H 3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H 4 /* 5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface 6 * 7 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH 9 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2020 Intel Corporation 11 */ 12 13 #include <linux/ethtool.h> 14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h> 15 #include <linux/netdevice.h> 16 #include <linux/debugfs.h> 17 #include <linux/list.h> 18 #include <linux/bug.h> 19 #include <linux/netlink.h> 20 #include <linux/skbuff.h> 21 #include <linux/nl80211.h> 22 #include <linux/if_ether.h> 23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h> 24 #include <linux/net.h> 25 #include <net/regulatory.h> 26 27 /** 28 * DOC: Introduction 29 * 30 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges 31 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated 32 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used 33 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent 34 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers 35 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely. 36 * 37 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum 38 * use restrictions. 39 */ 40 41 42 /** 43 * DOC: Device registration 44 * 45 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device 46 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs 47 * described below. 48 * 49 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each 50 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each 51 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with 52 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's 53 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes 54 * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the 55 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating 56 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the 57 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful. 58 * 59 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has 60 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and 61 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail. 62 */ 63 64 struct wiphy; 65 66 /* 67 * wireless hardware capability structures 68 */ 69 70 /** 71 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags 72 * 73 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code. 74 * 75 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled. 76 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes 77 * sending probe requests or beaconing. 78 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel. 79 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel 80 * is not permitted. 81 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel 82 * is not permitted. 83 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel. 84 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band, 85 * this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this 86 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 87 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 88 * restrictions. 89 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band, 90 * this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this 91 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 92 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 93 * restrictions. 94 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY 95 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 96 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 97 * on this channel. 98 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 99 * on this channel. 100 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel. 101 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted 102 * on this channel. 103 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted 104 * on this channel. 105 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted 106 * on this channel. 107 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted 108 * on this channel. 109 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted 110 * on this channel. 111 * 112 */ 113 enum ieee80211_channel_flags { 114 IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED = 1<<0, 115 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR = 1<<1, 116 /* hole at 1<<2 */ 117 IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR = 1<<3, 118 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS = 1<<4, 119 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS = 1<<5, 120 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM = 1<<6, 121 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ = 1<<7, 122 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ = 1<<8, 123 IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY = 1<<9, 124 IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT = 1<<10, 125 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ = 1<<11, 126 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ = 1<<12, 127 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE = 1<<13, 128 IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ = 1<<14, 129 IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ = 1<<15, 130 IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ = 1<<16, 131 IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ = 1<<17, 132 IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ = 1<<18, 133 }; 134 135 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \ 136 (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS) 137 138 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS 60000 139 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS (30 * 60 * 1000) 140 141 /** 142 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition 143 * 144 * This structure describes a single channel for use 145 * with cfg80211. 146 * 147 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz 148 * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz 149 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel 150 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags. 151 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory 152 * code to support devices with additional restrictions 153 * @band: band this channel belongs to. 154 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi 155 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm) 156 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm) 157 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon 158 * has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon() 159 * to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band. 160 * @orig_mag: internal use 161 * @orig_mpwr: internal use 162 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required 163 * on this channel. 164 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 165 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels. 166 */ 167 struct ieee80211_channel { 168 enum nl80211_band band; 169 u32 center_freq; 170 u16 freq_offset; 171 u16 hw_value; 172 u32 flags; 173 int max_antenna_gain; 174 int max_power; 175 int max_reg_power; 176 bool beacon_found; 177 u32 orig_flags; 178 int orig_mag, orig_mpwr; 179 enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state; 180 unsigned long dfs_state_entered; 181 unsigned int dfs_cac_ms; 182 }; 183 184 /** 185 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags 186 * 187 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured 188 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for 189 * different bands/PHY modes. 190 * 191 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short 192 * preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and 193 * with CCK rates. 194 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 195 * when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the 196 * core code when registering the wiphy. 197 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 198 * when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 199 * core code when registering the wiphy. 200 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 201 * when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 202 * core code when registering the wiphy. 203 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode. 204 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode 205 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode 206 */ 207 enum ieee80211_rate_flags { 208 IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<0, 209 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A = 1<<1, 210 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B = 1<<2, 211 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G = 1<<3, 212 IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G = 1<<4, 213 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ = 1<<5, 214 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ = 1<<6, 215 }; 216 217 /** 218 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter 219 * 220 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS 221 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS 222 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS 223 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS 224 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type 225 */ 226 enum ieee80211_bss_type { 227 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS, 228 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS, 229 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 230 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS, 231 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY 232 }; 233 234 /** 235 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter 236 * 237 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set 238 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear 239 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting 240 */ 241 enum ieee80211_privacy { 242 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON, 243 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF, 244 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY 245 }; 246 247 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x) \ 248 ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF) 249 250 /** 251 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition 252 * 253 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can 254 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short 255 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are 256 * passed around. 257 * 258 * @flags: rate-specific flags 259 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps 260 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate 261 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when 262 * short preamble is used 263 */ 264 struct ieee80211_rate { 265 u32 flags; 266 u16 bitrate; 267 u16 hw_value, hw_value_short; 268 }; 269 270 /** 271 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse 272 * 273 * @enable: is the feature enabled. 274 * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element. 275 * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset 276 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use 277 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use 278 * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by 279 * members of the SRG 280 * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values 281 * used by members of the SRG 282 */ 283 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd { 284 bool enable; 285 u8 sr_ctrl; 286 u8 non_srg_max_offset; 287 u8 min_offset; 288 u8 max_offset; 289 u8 bss_color_bitmap[8]; 290 u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8]; 291 }; 292 293 /** 294 * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring 295 * 296 * @color: the current color. 297 * @enabled: HE BSS color is used 298 * @partial: define the AID equation. 299 */ 300 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color { 301 u8 color; 302 bool enabled; 303 bool partial; 304 }; 305 306 /** 307 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities 308 * 309 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 310 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA. 311 * 312 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA 313 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec 314 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor 315 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing 316 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates 317 */ 318 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap { 319 u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */ 320 bool ht_supported; 321 u8 ampdu_factor; 322 u8 ampdu_density; 323 struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs; 324 }; 325 326 /** 327 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities 328 * 329 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 330 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA. 331 * 332 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA 333 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec 334 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates 335 */ 336 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap { 337 bool vht_supported; 338 u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */ 339 struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs; 340 }; 341 342 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 25 343 344 /** 345 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities 346 * 347 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 348 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA. 349 * 350 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid. 351 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element. 352 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. 353 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. 354 */ 355 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap { 356 bool has_he; 357 struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem; 358 struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp; 359 u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; 360 }; 361 362 /** 363 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type 364 * 365 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the 366 * interface types defined in @types_mask. Each type in the 367 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data. 368 * 369 * @types_mask: interface types mask 370 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities 371 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a 372 * 6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value). 373 */ 374 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data { 375 u16 types_mask; 376 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; 377 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; 378 }; 379 380 /** 381 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations 382 * 383 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz 384 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz 385 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz 386 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz 387 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 388 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 389 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 390 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and 391 * 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 392 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 393 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 394 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 395 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 396 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 397 * and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 398 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz, 399 * 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 400 */ 401 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config { 402 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4 = 4, 403 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5 = 5, 404 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6 = 6, 405 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7 = 7, 406 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8 = 8, 407 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9 = 9, 408 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10 = 10, 409 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11 = 11, 410 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12 = 12, 411 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13 = 13, 412 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14 = 14, 413 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15 = 15, 414 }; 415 416 /** 417 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration 418 * 419 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 420 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration 421 * 422 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s) 423 * that are allowed to be used for transmissions. 424 * Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc. 425 * Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported. 426 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes 427 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations 428 */ 429 struct ieee80211_edmg { 430 u8 channels; 431 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config; 432 }; 433 434 /** 435 * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities 436 * 437 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 438 * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA. 439 * 440 * @s1g_supported: is STA an S1G STA 441 * @cap: S1G capabilities information 442 * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set 443 */ 444 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap { 445 bool s1g; 446 u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */ 447 u8 nss_mcs[5]; 448 }; 449 450 /** 451 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition 452 * 453 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy 454 * is able to operate in. 455 * 456 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with 457 * in this band. 458 * @band: the band this structure represents 459 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels 460 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with 461 * in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported 462 * rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM. 463 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates 464 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band 465 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band 466 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band 467 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band 468 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course) 469 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries 470 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries. Note that the bits in 471 * @types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only 472 * one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of 473 * iftype_data). 474 */ 475 struct ieee80211_supported_band { 476 struct ieee80211_channel *channels; 477 struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates; 478 enum nl80211_band band; 479 int n_channels; 480 int n_bitrates; 481 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; 482 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; 483 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap; 484 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap; 485 u16 n_iftype_data; 486 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data; 487 }; 488 489 /** 490 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype 491 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 492 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 493 * 494 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found 495 */ 496 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * 497 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 498 u8 iftype) 499 { 500 int i; 501 502 if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX)) 503 return NULL; 504 505 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++) { 506 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 507 &sband->iftype_data[i]; 508 509 if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype)) 510 return data; 511 } 512 513 return NULL; 514 } 515 516 /** 517 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype 518 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 519 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 520 * 521 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found 522 */ 523 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 524 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 525 u8 iftype) 526 { 527 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 528 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 529 530 if (data && data->he_cap.has_he) 531 return &data->he_cap; 532 533 return NULL; 534 } 535 536 /** 537 * ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's STA 538 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 539 * 540 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found 541 */ 542 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 543 ieee80211_get_he_sta_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband) 544 { 545 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION); 546 } 547 548 /** 549 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities 550 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 551 * @iftype: the iftype to search for 552 * 553 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities 554 */ 555 static inline __le16 556 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 557 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 558 { 559 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 560 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 561 562 if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he)) 563 return 0; 564 565 return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa; 566 } 567 568 /** 569 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree 570 * 571 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for 572 * 573 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful 574 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board 575 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier). 576 * 577 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable 578 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with 579 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make 580 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified 581 * without affecting other devices. 582 * 583 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev. 584 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first. 585 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register(). 586 */ 587 #ifdef CONFIG_OF 588 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy); 589 #else /* CONFIG_OF */ 590 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy) 591 { 592 } 593 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */ 594 595 596 /* 597 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods 598 */ 599 600 /** 601 * DOC: Actions and configuration 602 * 603 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration 604 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these 605 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these 606 * operations use are described separately. 607 * 608 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status 609 * information via some functions that drivers need to call. 610 * 611 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described 612 * in a separate chapter. 613 */ 614 615 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\ 616 WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN) 617 618 /** 619 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters 620 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise 621 * %MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set 622 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames 623 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface. 624 * If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may 625 * determine the address as needed. 626 * This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the 627 * %NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag. Others may support creating 628 ** only p2p devices with specified MAC. 629 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets 630 * belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed 631 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring 632 * MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed 633 */ 634 struct vif_params { 635 u32 flags; 636 int use_4addr; 637 u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN]; 638 const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups; 639 const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr; 640 }; 641 642 /** 643 * struct key_params - key information 644 * 645 * Information about a key 646 * 647 * @key: key material 648 * @key_len: length of key material 649 * @cipher: cipher suite selector 650 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used 651 * with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian, 652 * length given by @seq_len. 653 * @seq_len: length of @seq. 654 * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero) 655 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX) 656 */ 657 struct key_params { 658 const u8 *key; 659 const u8 *seq; 660 int key_len; 661 int seq_len; 662 u16 vlan_id; 663 u32 cipher; 664 enum nl80211_key_mode mode; 665 }; 666 667 /** 668 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition 669 * @chan: the (control) channel 670 * @width: channel width 671 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment 672 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment 673 * (only with 80+80 MHz) 674 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration. 675 * If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero), 676 * chan will define the primary channel and all other 677 * parameters are ignored. 678 * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz 679 */ 680 struct cfg80211_chan_def { 681 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 682 enum nl80211_chan_width width; 683 u32 center_freq1; 684 u32 center_freq2; 685 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 686 u16 freq1_offset; 687 }; 688 689 /* 690 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control 691 */ 692 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask { 693 struct { 694 u32 legacy; 695 u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN]; 696 u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX]; 697 u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX]; 698 enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi; 699 enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi; 700 enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf; 701 } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 702 }; 703 704 705 /** 706 * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration 707 * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration 708 * of the peer. 709 * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify 710 * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed, 711 * similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp. 712 * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID 713 * @retry_long: retry count value 714 * @retry_short: retry count value 715 * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation 716 * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS 717 * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation 718 * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type 719 * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID 720 */ 721 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg { 722 bool config_override; 723 u8 tids; 724 u64 mask; 725 enum nl80211_tid_config noack; 726 u8 retry_long, retry_short; 727 enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu; 728 enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts; 729 enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu; 730 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type; 731 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask; 732 }; 733 734 /** 735 * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration 736 * @peer: Station's MAC address 737 * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied 738 * @tid_conf: Configuration change info 739 */ 740 struct cfg80211_tid_config { 741 const u8 *peer; 742 u32 n_tid_conf; 743 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[]; 744 }; 745 746 /** 747 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef 748 * @chandef: the channel definition 749 * 750 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given 751 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion. 752 */ 753 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type 754 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 755 { 756 switch (chandef->width) { 757 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 758 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 759 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 760 return NL80211_CHAN_HT20; 761 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 762 if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq) 763 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS; 764 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS; 765 default: 766 WARN_ON(1); 767 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 768 } 769 } 770 771 /** 772 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type 773 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill 774 * @channel: the control channel 775 * @chantype: the channel type 776 * 777 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition. 778 */ 779 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 780 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 781 enum nl80211_channel_type chantype); 782 783 /** 784 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical 785 * @chandef1: first channel definition 786 * @chandef2: second channel definition 787 * 788 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are 789 * identical, %false otherwise. 790 */ 791 static inline bool 792 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 793 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2) 794 { 795 return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan && 796 chandef1->width == chandef2->width && 797 chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 && 798 chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset && 799 chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2); 800 } 801 802 /** 803 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel 804 * 805 * @chandef: the channel definition 806 * 807 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise. 808 */ 809 static inline bool 810 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 811 { 812 return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config; 813 } 814 815 /** 816 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible 817 * @chandef1: first channel definition 818 * @chandef2: second channel definition 819 * 820 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible, 821 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise. 822 */ 823 const struct cfg80211_chan_def * 824 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 825 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2); 826 827 /** 828 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid 829 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 830 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise. 831 */ 832 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 833 834 /** 835 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used 836 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 837 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 838 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set 839 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise. 840 */ 841 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy, 842 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 843 u32 prohibited_flags); 844 845 /** 846 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required 847 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 848 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 849 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype 850 * Returns: 851 * 1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error 852 */ 853 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy, 854 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 855 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 856 857 /** 858 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel 859 * 860 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK 861 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels. 862 * 863 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 864 * 865 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel 866 */ 867 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags 868 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 869 { 870 switch (chandef->width) { 871 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 872 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ; 873 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 874 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ; 875 default: 876 break; 877 } 878 return 0; 879 } 880 881 /** 882 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef 883 * 884 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel 885 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual 886 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels. 887 * 888 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 889 * 890 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef 891 */ 892 static inline int 893 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 894 { 895 switch (chandef->width) { 896 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 897 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6, 898 chandef->chan->max_power); 899 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 900 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3, 901 chandef->chan->max_power); 902 default: 903 break; 904 } 905 return chandef->chan->max_power; 906 } 907 908 /** 909 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags 910 * 911 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in 912 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used 913 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in 914 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in 915 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in 916 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in 917 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in 918 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in 919 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in 920 * 921 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info 922 * it has filled in during the get_survey(). 923 */ 924 enum survey_info_flags { 925 SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM = BIT(0), 926 SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE = BIT(1), 927 SURVEY_INFO_TIME = BIT(2), 928 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY = BIT(3), 929 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY = BIT(4), 930 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX = BIT(5), 931 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX = BIT(6), 932 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN = BIT(7), 933 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX = BIT(8), 934 }; 935 936 /** 937 * struct survey_info - channel survey response 938 * 939 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single 940 * record to report global statistics 941 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags 942 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are 943 * optional 944 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel) 945 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy 946 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy 947 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data 948 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data 949 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning 950 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS 951 * 952 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information. 953 * 954 * This structure can later be expanded with things like 955 * channel duty cycle etc. 956 */ 957 struct survey_info { 958 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 959 u64 time; 960 u64 time_busy; 961 u64 time_ext_busy; 962 u64 time_rx; 963 u64 time_tx; 964 u64 time_scan; 965 u64 time_bss_rx; 966 u32 filled; 967 s8 noise; 968 }; 969 970 #define CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS 4 971 972 /** 973 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings 974 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled 975 * (from enum nl80211_wpa_versions) 976 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset) 977 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers 978 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites 979 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites 980 * @akm_suites: AKM suites 981 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 982 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 983 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 984 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 985 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be 986 * allowed through even on unauthorized ports 987 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port 988 * protocol frames. 989 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 990 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 991 * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control 992 * port for mac80211 993 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of 994 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys 995 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key 996 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload) 997 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE 998 * offload) 999 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload) 1000 * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation: 1001 * 1002 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED 1003 * Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any 1004 * preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in 1005 * such a scenario. 1006 * 1007 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK 1008 * Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only 1009 * 1010 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT 1011 * Allow hash-to-element only 1012 * 1013 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH 1014 * Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element 1015 */ 1016 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings { 1017 u32 wpa_versions; 1018 u32 cipher_group; 1019 int n_ciphers_pairwise; 1020 u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES]; 1021 int n_akm_suites; 1022 u32 akm_suites[NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES]; 1023 bool control_port; 1024 __be16 control_port_ethertype; 1025 bool control_port_no_encrypt; 1026 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 1027 bool control_port_no_preauth; 1028 struct key_params *wep_keys; 1029 int wep_tx_key; 1030 const u8 *psk; 1031 const u8 *sae_pwd; 1032 u8 sae_pwd_len; 1033 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe; 1034 }; 1035 1036 /** 1037 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data 1038 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE) 1039 * or %NULL if not changed 1040 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE) 1041 * or %NULL if not changed 1042 * @head_len: length of @head 1043 * @tail_len: length of @tail 1044 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL 1045 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets 1046 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response 1047 * frames or %NULL 1048 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets 1049 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association 1050 * Response frames or %NULL 1051 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets 1052 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp) 1053 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only) 1054 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change 1055 * (which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data) 1056 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token 1057 * (measurement type 8) 1058 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement 1059 * Token (measurement type 11) 1060 * @lci_len: LCI data length 1061 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length 1062 */ 1063 struct cfg80211_beacon_data { 1064 const u8 *head, *tail; 1065 const u8 *beacon_ies; 1066 const u8 *proberesp_ies; 1067 const u8 *assocresp_ies; 1068 const u8 *probe_resp; 1069 const u8 *lci; 1070 const u8 *civicloc; 1071 s8 ftm_responder; 1072 1073 size_t head_len, tail_len; 1074 size_t beacon_ies_len; 1075 size_t proberesp_ies_len; 1076 size_t assocresp_ies_len; 1077 size_t probe_resp_len; 1078 size_t lci_len; 1079 size_t civicloc_len; 1080 }; 1081 1082 struct mac_address { 1083 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 1084 }; 1085 1086 /** 1087 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data 1088 * 1089 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's 1090 * entry specified by mac_addr 1091 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed 1092 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL 1093 */ 1094 struct cfg80211_acl_data { 1095 enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy; 1096 int n_acl_entries; 1097 1098 /* Keep it last */ 1099 struct mac_address mac_addrs[]; 1100 }; 1101 1102 /** 1103 * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from 1104 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 1105 * 1106 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1107 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1108 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1109 * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action 1110 * frame headers. 1111 */ 1112 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery { 1113 u32 min_interval; 1114 u32 max_interval; 1115 size_t tmpl_len; 1116 const u8 *tmpl; 1117 }; 1118 1119 /** 1120 * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe 1121 * response parameters in 6GHz. 1122 * 1123 * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned 1124 * in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive 1125 * scanning 1126 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1127 * @tmpl: Template data for probe response 1128 */ 1129 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp { 1130 u32 interval; 1131 size_t tmpl_len; 1132 const u8 *tmpl; 1133 }; 1134 1135 /** 1136 * enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags 1137 * 1138 * Used by cfg80211_ap_settings 1139 * 1140 * @AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external authentication 1141 */ 1142 enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags { 1143 AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(0), 1144 }; 1145 1146 /** 1147 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration 1148 * 1149 * Used to configure an AP interface. 1150 * 1151 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 1152 * @beacon: beacon data 1153 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1154 * @dtim_period: DTIM period 1155 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from 1156 * user space) 1157 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid 1158 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames 1159 * @crypto: crypto settings 1160 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy 1161 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 1162 * @smps_mode: SMPS mode 1163 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity. 1164 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window 1165 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS 1166 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for 1167 * MAC address based access control 1168 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG 1169 * networks. 1170 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 1171 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled) 1172 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled) 1173 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1174 * @ht_required: stations must support HT 1175 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT 1176 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time 1177 * @he_required: stations must support HE 1178 * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE 1179 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags 1180 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings 1181 * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings 1182 * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1183 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters 1184 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters 1185 */ 1186 struct cfg80211_ap_settings { 1187 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1188 1189 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon; 1190 1191 int beacon_interval, dtim_period; 1192 const u8 *ssid; 1193 size_t ssid_len; 1194 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid; 1195 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 1196 bool privacy; 1197 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 1198 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 1199 int inactivity_timeout; 1200 u8 p2p_ctwindow; 1201 bool p2p_opp_ps; 1202 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl; 1203 bool pbss; 1204 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 1205 1206 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap; 1207 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap; 1208 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap; 1209 const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper; 1210 bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required; 1211 bool twt_responder; 1212 u32 flags; 1213 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; 1214 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; 1215 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 1216 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp; 1217 }; 1218 1219 /** 1220 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings 1221 * 1222 * Used for channel switch 1223 * 1224 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch 1225 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch 1226 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) 1227 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response 1228 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail) 1229 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response 1230 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel 1231 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel 1232 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing 1233 * @count: number of beacons until switch 1234 */ 1235 struct cfg80211_csa_settings { 1236 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1237 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa; 1238 const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon; 1239 const u16 *counter_offsets_presp; 1240 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon; 1241 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp; 1242 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after; 1243 bool radar_required; 1244 bool block_tx; 1245 u8 count; 1246 }; 1247 1248 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_DIFFERENT_CHANNELS 10 1249 1250 /** 1251 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations 1252 * 1253 * Used to pass interface combination parameters 1254 * 1255 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want 1256 * to use for verification 1257 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel 1258 * width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of 1259 * &struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths 1260 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface 1261 * type. The index is the interface type as specified in &enum 1262 * nl80211_iftype. 1263 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface 1264 * that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of 1265 * the verification 1266 */ 1267 struct iface_combination_params { 1268 int num_different_channels; 1269 u8 radar_detect; 1270 int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES]; 1271 u32 new_beacon_int; 1272 }; 1273 1274 /** 1275 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply 1276 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp) 1277 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability 1278 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state 1279 * 1280 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling, 1281 * for those that don't these flags will are used. 1282 */ 1283 enum station_parameters_apply_mask { 1284 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0), 1285 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1), 1286 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2), 1287 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_STA_TXPOWER = BIT(3), 1288 }; 1289 1290 /** 1291 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration 1292 * 1293 * Used to configure txpower for station. 1294 * 1295 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power 1296 * is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be 1297 * overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx 1298 * power per-interface or per-station. 1299 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power 1300 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC 1301 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. 1302 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for 1303 * per peer TPC. 1304 */ 1305 struct sta_txpwr { 1306 s16 power; 1307 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; 1308 }; 1309 1310 /** 1311 * struct station_parameters - station parameters 1312 * 1313 * Used to change and create a new station. 1314 * 1315 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to 1316 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format 1317 * (or NULL for no change) 1318 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates 1319 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed 1320 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1321 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values 1322 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1323 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change 1324 * @aid: AID or zero for no change 1325 * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero) 1326 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change 1327 * @plink_action: plink action to take 1328 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station 1329 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station 1330 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station 1331 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format 1332 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 1333 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the 1334 * QoS info field (but already shifted down) 1335 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed 1336 * (for those that don't have a natural "no change" value), 1337 * see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask 1338 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set 1339 * to unknown) 1340 * @capability: station capability 1341 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station 1342 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities 1343 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format 1344 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels 1345 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format 1346 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes 1347 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification 1348 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used 1349 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism 1350 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station 1351 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities 1352 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station 1353 * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station 1354 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station 1355 */ 1356 struct station_parameters { 1357 const u8 *supported_rates; 1358 struct net_device *vlan; 1359 u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set; 1360 u32 sta_modify_mask; 1361 int listen_interval; 1362 u16 aid; 1363 u16 vlan_id; 1364 u16 peer_aid; 1365 u8 supported_rates_len; 1366 u8 plink_action; 1367 u8 plink_state; 1368 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa; 1369 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa; 1370 u8 uapsd_queues; 1371 u8 max_sp; 1372 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 1373 u16 capability; 1374 const u8 *ext_capab; 1375 u8 ext_capab_len; 1376 const u8 *supported_channels; 1377 u8 supported_channels_len; 1378 const u8 *supported_oper_classes; 1379 u8 supported_oper_classes_len; 1380 u8 opmode_notif; 1381 bool opmode_notif_used; 1382 int support_p2p_ps; 1383 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa; 1384 u8 he_capa_len; 1385 u16 airtime_weight; 1386 struct sta_txpwr txpwr; 1387 const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa; 1388 }; 1389 1390 /** 1391 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters 1392 * 1393 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations). 1394 * 1395 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations 1396 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal 1397 * (10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication) 1398 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame 1399 */ 1400 struct station_del_parameters { 1401 const u8 *mac; 1402 u8 subtype; 1403 u16 reason_code; 1404 }; 1405 1406 /** 1407 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified 1408 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface 1409 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still 1410 * unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted) 1411 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has 1412 * the AP MLME in the device 1413 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface 1414 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station 1415 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry 1416 * while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when 1417 * being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is 1418 * supported/used) 1419 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active 1420 * entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace) 1421 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed) 1422 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed) 1423 */ 1424 enum cfg80211_station_type { 1425 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT, 1426 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC, 1427 CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT, 1428 CFG80211_STA_AP_STA, 1429 CFG80211_STA_IBSS, 1430 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP, 1431 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE, 1432 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL, 1433 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER, 1434 }; 1435 1436 /** 1437 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes 1438 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on 1439 * @params: the new parameters for a station 1440 * @statype: the type of station being modified 1441 * 1442 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function 1443 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that 1444 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if 1445 * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for 1446 * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this. 1447 */ 1448 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1449 struct station_parameters *params, 1450 enum cfg80211_station_type statype); 1451 1452 /** 1453 * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags 1454 * 1455 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1456 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1457 * 1458 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS 1459 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS 1460 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval 1461 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS 1462 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information 1463 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode 1464 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS 1465 */ 1466 enum rate_info_flags { 1467 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS = BIT(0), 1468 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS = BIT(1), 1469 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), 1470 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG = BIT(3), 1471 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS = BIT(4), 1472 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG = BIT(5), 1473 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG = BIT(6), 1474 }; 1475 1476 /** 1477 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information 1478 * 1479 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth. 1480 * 1481 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth 1482 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth 1483 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth 1484 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth 1485 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth 1486 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth 1487 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation 1488 */ 1489 enum rate_info_bw { 1490 RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0, 1491 RATE_INFO_BW_5, 1492 RATE_INFO_BW_10, 1493 RATE_INFO_BW_40, 1494 RATE_INFO_BW_80, 1495 RATE_INFO_BW_160, 1496 RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU, 1497 }; 1498 1499 /** 1500 * struct rate_info - bitrate information 1501 * 1502 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate 1503 * 1504 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags 1505 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE rate 1506 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg 1507 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only) 1508 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw) 1509 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi) 1510 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value 1511 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc, 1512 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU) 1513 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4) 1514 */ 1515 struct rate_info { 1516 u8 flags; 1517 u8 mcs; 1518 u16 legacy; 1519 u8 nss; 1520 u8 bw; 1521 u8 he_gi; 1522 u8 he_dcm; 1523 u8 he_ru_alloc; 1524 u8 n_bonded_ch; 1525 }; 1526 1527 /** 1528 * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags 1529 * 1530 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1531 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1532 * 1533 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled 1534 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 1535 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled 1536 */ 1537 enum bss_param_flags { 1538 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT = 1<<0, 1539 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<1, 1540 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME = 1<<2, 1541 }; 1542 1543 /** 1544 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station 1545 * 1546 * Information about the currently associated BSS 1547 * 1548 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags 1549 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS 1550 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1551 */ 1552 struct sta_bss_parameters { 1553 u8 flags; 1554 u8 dtim_period; 1555 u16 beacon_interval; 1556 }; 1557 1558 /** 1559 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID 1560 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to 1561 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1562 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged 1563 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged 1564 * @flows: number of new flows seen 1565 * @drops: total number of packets dropped 1566 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE 1567 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow 1568 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow 1569 * @collisions: number of hash collisions 1570 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued 1571 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued 1572 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported 1573 */ 1574 struct cfg80211_txq_stats { 1575 u32 filled; 1576 u32 backlog_bytes; 1577 u32 backlog_packets; 1578 u32 flows; 1579 u32 drops; 1580 u32 ecn_marks; 1581 u32 overlimit; 1582 u32 overmemory; 1583 u32 collisions; 1584 u32 tx_bytes; 1585 u32 tx_packets; 1586 u32 max_flows; 1587 }; 1588 1589 /** 1590 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics 1591 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to 1592 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1593 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs 1594 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs 1595 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for 1596 * transmitted MSDUs 1597 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs 1598 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics 1599 */ 1600 struct cfg80211_tid_stats { 1601 u32 filled; 1602 u64 rx_msdu; 1603 u64 tx_msdu; 1604 u64 tx_msdu_retries; 1605 u64 tx_msdu_failed; 1606 struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats; 1607 }; 1608 1609 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS 4 1610 1611 /** 1612 * struct station_info - station information 1613 * 1614 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station. 1615 * 1616 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to 1617 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 1618 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected 1619 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds 1620 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association 1621 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station 1622 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station 1623 * @llid: mesh local link id 1624 * @plid: mesh peer link id 1625 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state 1626 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1627 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1628 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1629 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1630 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg 1631 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm 1632 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm 1633 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station 1634 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station 1635 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station 1636 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station 1637 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs) 1638 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK) 1639 * @rx_dropped_misc: Dropped for un-specified reason. 1640 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters 1641 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 1642 * This number should increase every time the list of stations 1643 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 1644 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 1645 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request. 1646 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use 1647 * user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for 1648 * the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. 1649 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets. 1650 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values 1651 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered. 1652 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host. 1653 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode 1654 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode 1655 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode 1656 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers) 1657 * towards this station. 1658 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer 1659 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received 1660 * from this peer 1661 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate 1662 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer 1663 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer 1664 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight 1665 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last 1666 * (IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs. 1667 * Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL. 1668 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame. 1669 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has 1670 * been sent. 1671 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station 1672 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with 1673 * an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the 1674 * received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address. 1675 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric. 1676 * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server 1677 */ 1678 struct station_info { 1679 u64 filled; 1680 u32 connected_time; 1681 u32 inactive_time; 1682 u64 assoc_at; 1683 u64 rx_bytes; 1684 u64 tx_bytes; 1685 u16 llid; 1686 u16 plid; 1687 u8 plink_state; 1688 s8 signal; 1689 s8 signal_avg; 1690 1691 u8 chains; 1692 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1693 s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 1694 1695 struct rate_info txrate; 1696 struct rate_info rxrate; 1697 u32 rx_packets; 1698 u32 tx_packets; 1699 u32 tx_retries; 1700 u32 tx_failed; 1701 u32 rx_dropped_misc; 1702 struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param; 1703 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags; 1704 1705 int generation; 1706 1707 const u8 *assoc_req_ies; 1708 size_t assoc_req_ies_len; 1709 1710 u32 beacon_loss_count; 1711 s64 t_offset; 1712 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 1713 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm; 1714 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm; 1715 1716 u32 expected_throughput; 1717 1718 u64 tx_duration; 1719 u64 rx_duration; 1720 u64 rx_beacon; 1721 u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg; 1722 u8 connected_to_gate; 1723 1724 struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid; 1725 s8 ack_signal; 1726 s8 avg_ack_signal; 1727 1728 u16 airtime_weight; 1729 1730 u32 rx_mpdu_count; 1731 u32 fcs_err_count; 1732 1733 u32 airtime_link_metric; 1734 1735 u8 connected_to_as; 1736 }; 1737 1738 /** 1739 * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit 1740 * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm 1741 * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to 1742 */ 1743 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs { 1744 s32 power; 1745 u32 freq_range_index; 1746 }; 1747 1748 /** 1749 * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs 1750 * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types 1751 * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs 1752 * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs 1753 */ 1754 struct cfg80211_sar_specs { 1755 enum nl80211_sar_type type; 1756 u32 num_sub_specs; 1757 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[]; 1758 }; 1759 1760 1761 /** 1762 * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges 1763 * @start_freq: start range edge frequency 1764 * @end_freq: end range edge frequency 1765 */ 1766 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges { 1767 u32 start_freq; 1768 u32 end_freq; 1769 }; 1770 1771 /** 1772 * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability 1773 * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types 1774 * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges 1775 * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges. 1776 * 1777 * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing 1778 * range to small ones and then append them. 1779 */ 1780 struct cfg80211_sar_capa { 1781 enum nl80211_sar_type type; 1782 u32 num_freq_ranges; 1783 const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges; 1784 }; 1785 1786 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) 1787 /** 1788 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station 1789 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to 1790 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest 1791 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information 1792 * 1793 * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information 1794 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be 1795 * considered undefined. 1796 */ 1797 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 1798 struct station_info *sinfo); 1799 #else 1800 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, 1801 const u8 *mac_addr, 1802 struct station_info *sinfo) 1803 { 1804 return -ENOENT; 1805 } 1806 #endif 1807 1808 /** 1809 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags 1810 * 1811 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits 1812 * according to the nl80211 flags. 1813 * 1814 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed 1815 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS 1816 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP 1817 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames 1818 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering 1819 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing 1820 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address 1821 */ 1822 enum monitor_flags { 1823 MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED = 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID, 1824 MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL, 1825 MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL, 1826 MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL, 1827 MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS, 1828 MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES, 1829 MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE, 1830 }; 1831 1832 /** 1833 * enum mpath_info_flags - mesh path information flags 1834 * 1835 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled 1836 * in during get_station() or dump_station(). 1837 * 1838 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled 1839 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled 1840 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled 1841 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled 1842 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled 1843 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled 1844 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled 1845 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled 1846 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled 1847 */ 1848 enum mpath_info_flags { 1849 MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN = BIT(0), 1850 MPATH_INFO_SN = BIT(1), 1851 MPATH_INFO_METRIC = BIT(2), 1852 MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME = BIT(3), 1853 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT = BIT(4), 1854 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES = BIT(5), 1855 MPATH_INFO_FLAGS = BIT(6), 1856 MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT = BIT(7), 1857 MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE = BIT(8), 1858 }; 1859 1860 /** 1861 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information 1862 * 1863 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath(). 1864 * 1865 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags 1866 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination 1867 * @sn: target sequence number 1868 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path 1869 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs 1870 * @flags: mesh path flags 1871 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs 1872 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries 1873 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 1874 * This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths 1875 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 1876 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 1877 * @hop_count: hops to destination 1878 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination 1879 */ 1880 struct mpath_info { 1881 u32 filled; 1882 u32 frame_qlen; 1883 u32 sn; 1884 u32 metric; 1885 u32 exptime; 1886 u32 discovery_timeout; 1887 u8 discovery_retries; 1888 u8 flags; 1889 u8 hop_count; 1890 u32 path_change_count; 1891 1892 int generation; 1893 }; 1894 1895 /** 1896 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters 1897 * 1898 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode). 1899 * 1900 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection 1901 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1902 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed 1903 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1904 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed 1905 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1906 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format 1907 * (or NULL for no change) 1908 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates 1909 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations 1910 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 1911 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode 1912 * (u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change) 1913 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change) 1914 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change) 1915 */ 1916 struct bss_parameters { 1917 int use_cts_prot; 1918 int use_short_preamble; 1919 int use_short_slot_time; 1920 const u8 *basic_rates; 1921 u8 basic_rates_len; 1922 int ap_isolate; 1923 int ht_opmode; 1924 s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps; 1925 }; 1926 1927 /** 1928 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration 1929 * 1930 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active. 1931 * 1932 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used 1933 * by the Mesh Peering Open message 1934 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units 1935 * used by the Mesh Peering Open message 1936 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by 1937 * the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering 1938 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this 1939 * mesh interface 1940 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can 1941 * be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh 1942 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA 1943 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection 1944 * elements 1945 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we 1946 * detect compatible mesh peers 1947 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to 1948 * synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method 1949 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ 1950 * that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target 1951 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds 1952 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on 1953 * a path discovery in milliseconds 1954 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 1955 * receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the 1956 * root to be valid. (TU = time unit) 1957 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 1958 * which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ 1959 * element 1960 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 1961 * which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR 1962 * element 1963 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that 1964 * it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh 1965 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA 1966 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root 1967 * announcements are transmitted 1968 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh 1969 * station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is 1970 * missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true 1971 * only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but 1972 * not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the 1973 * same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec) 1974 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding 1975 * entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity) 1976 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate 1977 * station to establish a peer link 1978 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode 1979 * 1980 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 1981 * receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to 1982 * the root mesh STA to be valid. 1983 * 1984 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive 1985 * PREQs are transmitted. 1986 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs) 1987 * during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing 1988 * a PREQ element for root path confirmation. 1989 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial 1990 * setting for new peer links. 1991 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake 1992 * after transmitting its beacon. 1993 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established 1994 * peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it 1995 * from the STA's list of peers. Default is 30 minutes. 1996 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is 1997 * connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info. If false, the 1998 * value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths 1999 * in the mesh path table 2000 * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP 2001 * for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might 2002 * not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So 2003 * if using this setting you will likely also want to disable 2004 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top. 2005 */ 2006 struct mesh_config { 2007 u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout; 2008 u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout; 2009 u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout; 2010 u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks; 2011 u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries; 2012 u8 dot11MeshTTL; 2013 u8 element_ttl; 2014 bool auto_open_plinks; 2015 u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor; 2016 u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries; 2017 u32 path_refresh_time; 2018 u16 min_discovery_timeout; 2019 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout; 2020 u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval; 2021 u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval; 2022 u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime; 2023 u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode; 2024 bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate; 2025 bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer; 2026 u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval; 2027 bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol; 2028 bool dot11MeshForwarding; 2029 s32 rssi_threshold; 2030 u16 ht_opmode; 2031 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout; 2032 u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval; 2033 u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval; 2034 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode; 2035 u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration; 2036 u32 plink_timeout; 2037 bool dot11MeshNolearn; 2038 }; 2039 2040 /** 2041 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration 2042 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 2043 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID 2044 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes 2045 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use 2046 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use 2047 * @path_metric: which metric to use 2048 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using 2049 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional) 2050 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements 2051 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication 2052 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security 2053 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions 2054 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use 2055 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 2056 * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a] 2057 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh 2058 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 2059 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 2060 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 2061 * to operate on DFS channels. 2062 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 2063 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 2064 * 2065 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created. 2066 */ 2067 struct mesh_setup { 2068 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2069 const u8 *mesh_id; 2070 u8 mesh_id_len; 2071 u8 sync_method; 2072 u8 path_sel_proto; 2073 u8 path_metric; 2074 u8 auth_id; 2075 const u8 *ie; 2076 u8 ie_len; 2077 bool is_authenticated; 2078 bool is_secure; 2079 bool user_mpm; 2080 u8 dtim_period; 2081 u16 beacon_interval; 2082 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2083 u32 basic_rates; 2084 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 2085 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 2086 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 2087 }; 2088 2089 /** 2090 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration 2091 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 2092 * 2093 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network 2094 */ 2095 struct ocb_setup { 2096 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2097 }; 2098 2099 /** 2100 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters 2101 * @ac: AC identifier 2102 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled 2103 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2104 * 1..32767] 2105 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2106 * 1..32767] 2107 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255] 2108 */ 2109 struct ieee80211_txq_params { 2110 enum nl80211_ac ac; 2111 u16 txop; 2112 u16 cwmin; 2113 u16 cwmax; 2114 u8 aifs; 2115 }; 2116 2117 /** 2118 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling 2119 * 2120 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite 2121 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will 2122 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the 2123 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the 2124 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to 2125 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements 2126 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be 2127 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised 2128 * in the wiphy structure. 2129 * 2130 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because 2131 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not 2132 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist. 2133 * 2134 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of 2135 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the 2136 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available 2137 * to userspace. 2138 */ 2139 2140 /** 2141 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description 2142 * @ssid: the SSID 2143 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid 2144 */ 2145 struct cfg80211_ssid { 2146 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 2147 u8 ssid_len; 2148 }; 2149 2150 /** 2151 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan 2152 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the 2153 * wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this 2154 * information is not available, this field is left zero. 2155 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set. 2156 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason, 2157 * userspace will be notified of that 2158 */ 2159 struct cfg80211_scan_info { 2160 u64 scan_start_tsf; 2161 u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2162 bool aborted; 2163 }; 2164 2165 /** 2166 * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only 2167 * 2168 * @short_bssid: short ssid to scan for 2169 * @bssid: bssid to scan for 2170 * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request 2171 * which the above info relvant to 2172 * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU 2173 * @short_ssid_valid: short_ssid is valid and can be used 2174 * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait 2175 * 20 TUs before starting to send probe requests. 2176 */ 2177 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params { 2178 u32 short_ssid; 2179 u32 channel_idx; 2180 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2181 bool unsolicited_probe; 2182 bool short_ssid_valid; 2183 bool psc_no_listen; 2184 }; 2185 2186 /** 2187 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description 2188 * 2189 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only) 2190 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2191 * @channels: channels to scan on. 2192 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2193 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning 2194 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2195 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2196 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If 2197 * %duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and 2198 * the actual dwell time may be shorter. 2199 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the 2200 * %duration field. 2201 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation 2202 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band 2203 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2204 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started 2205 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for 2206 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan 2207 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted 2208 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band 2209 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2210 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2211 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2212 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2213 * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only, 2214 * true if this is the second scan request 2215 * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params 2216 * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params 2217 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID) 2218 */ 2219 struct cfg80211_scan_request { 2220 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2221 int n_ssids; 2222 u32 n_channels; 2223 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2224 const u8 *ie; 2225 size_t ie_len; 2226 u16 duration; 2227 bool duration_mandatory; 2228 u32 flags; 2229 2230 u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2231 2232 struct wireless_dev *wdev; 2233 2234 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2235 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2236 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2237 2238 /* internal */ 2239 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2240 unsigned long scan_start; 2241 struct cfg80211_scan_info info; 2242 bool notified; 2243 bool no_cck; 2244 bool scan_6ghz; 2245 u32 n_6ghz_params; 2246 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params; 2247 2248 /* keep last */ 2249 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; 2250 }; 2251 2252 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask) 2253 { 2254 int i; 2255 2256 get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN); 2257 for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) { 2258 buf[i] &= ~mask[i]; 2259 buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i]; 2260 } 2261 } 2262 2263 /** 2264 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match 2265 * 2266 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match 2267 * or no match (RSSI only) 2268 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match 2269 * or no match (RSSI only) 2270 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm) 2271 * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied 2272 * for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support 2273 * of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability 2274 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band 2275 * specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified. 2276 * If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of 2277 * corresponding matchset. 2278 */ 2279 struct cfg80211_match_set { 2280 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 2281 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2282 s32 rssi_thold; 2283 s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2284 }; 2285 2286 /** 2287 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan 2288 * 2289 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds. 2290 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means 2291 * infinite loop. 2292 * The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero, 2293 * all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations. 2294 */ 2295 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan { 2296 u32 interval; 2297 u32 iterations; 2298 }; 2299 2300 /** 2301 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment. 2302 * 2303 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment. 2304 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment. 2305 */ 2306 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust { 2307 enum nl80211_band band; 2308 s8 delta; 2309 }; 2310 2311 /** 2312 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description 2313 * 2314 * @reqid: identifies this request. 2315 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans) 2316 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2317 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2318 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning 2319 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2320 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2321 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation 2322 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result 2323 * entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host 2324 * (others are filtered out). 2325 * If ommited, all results are passed. 2326 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets 2327 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request 2328 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2329 * @dev: the interface 2330 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan 2331 * @channels: channels to scan 2332 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this 2333 * contains the minimum over all matchsets 2334 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2335 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2336 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2337 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2338 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest 2339 * index must be executed first. 2340 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1. 2341 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct 2342 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request 2343 * owned by a particular socket) 2344 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed 2345 * @list: for keeping list of requests. 2346 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan 2347 * cycle. The driver may ignore this parameter and start 2348 * immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not 2349 * supported. 2350 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not. 2351 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result 2352 * reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined 2353 * to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS. 2354 * The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state. 2355 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong 2356 * to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported 2357 * using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that 2358 * belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative 2359 * comparisions. 2360 */ 2361 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request { 2362 u64 reqid; 2363 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2364 int n_ssids; 2365 u32 n_channels; 2366 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2367 const u8 *ie; 2368 size_t ie_len; 2369 u32 flags; 2370 struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets; 2371 int n_match_sets; 2372 s32 min_rssi_thold; 2373 u32 delay; 2374 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans; 2375 int n_scan_plans; 2376 2377 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2378 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2379 2380 bool relative_rssi_set; 2381 s8 relative_rssi; 2382 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust; 2383 2384 /* internal */ 2385 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2386 struct net_device *dev; 2387 unsigned long scan_start; 2388 bool report_results; 2389 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2390 u32 owner_nlportid; 2391 bool nl_owner_dead; 2392 struct list_head list; 2393 2394 /* keep last */ 2395 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; 2396 }; 2397 2398 /** 2399 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type 2400 * 2401 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available 2402 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm) 2403 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100 2404 */ 2405 enum cfg80211_signal_type { 2406 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE, 2407 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, 2408 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC, 2409 }; 2410 2411 /** 2412 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data 2413 * @chan: channel the frame was received on 2414 * @scan_width: scan width that was used 2415 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's 2416 * signal type 2417 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was 2418 * received; should match the time when the frame was actually 2419 * received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was 2420 * buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms. 2421 * If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of 2422 * ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate. 2423 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the 2424 * timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified 2425 * by %parent_bssid. 2426 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to 2427 * the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received. 2428 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2429 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2430 */ 2431 struct cfg80211_inform_bss { 2432 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 2433 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2434 s32 signal; 2435 u64 boottime_ns; 2436 u64 parent_tsf; 2437 u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2438 u8 chains; 2439 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2440 }; 2441 2442 /** 2443 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data 2444 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs 2445 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing 2446 * @len: length of the IEs 2447 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon 2448 * @data: IE data 2449 */ 2450 struct cfg80211_bss_ies { 2451 u64 tsf; 2452 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2453 int len; 2454 bool from_beacon; 2455 u8 data[]; 2456 }; 2457 2458 /** 2459 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description 2460 * 2461 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network) 2462 * for use in scan results and similar. 2463 * 2464 * @channel: channel this BSS is on 2465 * @scan_width: width of the control channel 2466 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS 2467 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame 2468 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order 2469 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these 2470 * are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or 2471 * proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been 2472 * received. It is always non-%NULL. 2473 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame 2474 * (implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't 2475 * own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the 2476 * @hidden_beacon_bss struct) 2477 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame 2478 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from 2479 * a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct 2480 * that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and 2481 * points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case. 2482 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a 2483 * non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support) 2484 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one 2485 * (multi-BSSID support) 2486 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type) 2487 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2488 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2489 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set 2490 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set 2491 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes 2492 */ 2493 struct cfg80211_bss { 2494 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 2495 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width; 2496 2497 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies; 2498 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies; 2499 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies; 2500 2501 struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss; 2502 struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss; 2503 struct list_head nontrans_list; 2504 2505 s32 signal; 2506 2507 u16 beacon_interval; 2508 u16 capability; 2509 2510 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2511 u8 chains; 2512 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2513 2514 u8 bssid_index; 2515 u8 max_bssid_indicator; 2516 2517 u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2518 }; 2519 2520 /** 2521 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID 2522 * @bss: the bss to search 2523 * @id: the element ID 2524 * 2525 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2526 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2527 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2528 */ 2529 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id); 2530 2531 /** 2532 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID 2533 * @bss: the bss to search 2534 * @id: the element ID 2535 * 2536 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2537 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2538 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2539 */ 2540 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id) 2541 { 2542 return (void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id); 2543 } 2544 2545 2546 /** 2547 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data 2548 * 2549 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2550 * authentication. 2551 * 2552 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference 2553 * to it if it needs to keep it. 2554 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 2555 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL 2556 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2557 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 2558 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 2559 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 2560 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains 2561 * the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the 2562 * Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication 2563 * transaction sequence number field. 2564 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets 2565 */ 2566 struct cfg80211_auth_request { 2567 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2568 const u8 *ie; 2569 size_t ie_len; 2570 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 2571 const u8 *key; 2572 u8 key_len, key_idx; 2573 const u8 *auth_data; 2574 size_t auth_data_len; 2575 }; 2576 2577 /** 2578 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association. 2579 * 2580 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT: Disable HT (802.11n) 2581 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT: Disable VHT 2582 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association 2583 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external 2584 * authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to 2585 * userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect() 2586 * request (connect callback). 2587 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE: Disable HE 2588 */ 2589 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags { 2590 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT = BIT(0), 2591 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT = BIT(1), 2592 ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM = BIT(2), 2593 CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(3), 2594 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE = BIT(4), 2595 }; 2596 2597 /** 2598 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data 2599 * 2600 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2601 * (re)association. 2602 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is 2603 * given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc() 2604 * or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new 2605 * association requests while already associating must be rejected. 2606 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL 2607 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2608 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association 2609 * @crypto: crypto settings 2610 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 2611 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 2612 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 2613 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 2614 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 2615 * frame. 2616 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 2617 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2618 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2619 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2620 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override 2621 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use 2622 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or 2623 * %NULL if FILS is not used. 2624 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets 2625 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association 2626 * Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts 2627 * with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce. 2628 * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override 2629 * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask 2630 */ 2631 struct cfg80211_assoc_request { 2632 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2633 const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid; 2634 size_t ie_len; 2635 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 2636 bool use_mfp; 2637 u32 flags; 2638 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2639 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2640 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask; 2641 const u8 *fils_kek; 2642 size_t fils_kek_len; 2643 const u8 *fils_nonces; 2644 struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask; 2645 }; 2646 2647 /** 2648 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data 2649 * 2650 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2651 * deauthentication. 2652 * 2653 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS to deauthenticate from 2654 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL 2655 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2656 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication 2657 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and 2658 * do not set a deauth frame 2659 */ 2660 struct cfg80211_deauth_request { 2661 const u8 *bssid; 2662 const u8 *ie; 2663 size_t ie_len; 2664 u16 reason_code; 2665 bool local_state_change; 2666 }; 2667 2668 /** 2669 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data 2670 * 2671 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2672 * disassociation. 2673 * 2674 * @bss: the BSS to disassociate from 2675 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL 2676 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2677 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation 2678 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no 2679 * Disassociation frame is to be transmitted. 2680 */ 2681 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request { 2682 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2683 const u8 *ie; 2684 size_t ie_len; 2685 u16 reason_code; 2686 bool local_state_change; 2687 }; 2688 2689 /** 2690 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters 2691 * 2692 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss() 2693 * method. 2694 * 2695 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null. 2696 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero. 2697 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not 2698 * search for IBSSs with a different BSSID. 2699 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found 2700 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for 2701 * IBSSs to join on other channels. 2702 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon 2703 * @ie_len: length of that 2704 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 2705 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured 2706 * after joining 2707 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 2708 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 2709 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 2710 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 2711 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 2712 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 2713 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 2714 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 2715 * to operate on DFS channels. 2716 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS 2717 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) 2718 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2719 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2720 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2721 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of 2722 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys 2723 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key 2724 */ 2725 struct cfg80211_ibss_params { 2726 const u8 *ssid; 2727 const u8 *bssid; 2728 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2729 const u8 *ie; 2730 u8 ssid_len, ie_len; 2731 u16 beacon_interval; 2732 u32 basic_rates; 2733 bool channel_fixed; 2734 bool privacy; 2735 bool control_port; 2736 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 2737 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 2738 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2739 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2740 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2741 struct key_params *wep_keys; 2742 int wep_tx_key; 2743 }; 2744 2745 /** 2746 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection. 2747 * 2748 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour. 2749 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour. 2750 * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF. 2751 * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST. 2752 */ 2753 struct cfg80211_bss_selection { 2754 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour; 2755 union { 2756 enum nl80211_band band_pref; 2757 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust; 2758 } param; 2759 }; 2760 2761 /** 2762 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters 2763 * 2764 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2765 * authentication and association. 2766 * 2767 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based 2768 * on scan results) 2769 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or 2770 * %NULL if not specified 2771 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan 2772 * results) 2773 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or 2774 * %NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is 2775 * allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS 2776 * to use. 2777 * @ssid: SSID 2778 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets 2779 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 2780 * @ie: IEs for association request 2781 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets 2782 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used 2783 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used 2784 * @crypto: crypto settings 2785 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 2786 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 2787 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 2788 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 2789 * @bg_scan_period: Background scan period in seconds 2790 * or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used. 2791 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 2792 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 2793 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 2794 * @vht_capa: VHT Capability overrides 2795 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used. 2796 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG 2797 * networks. 2798 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection. 2799 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 2800 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 2801 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 2802 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 2803 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 2804 * frame. 2805 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the 2806 * NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped 2807 * data IE. 2808 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets. 2809 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or 2810 * %NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and 2811 * is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 2812 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets. 2813 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP 2814 * messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 2815 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional 2816 * keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified. 2817 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets. 2818 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver 2819 * offload of 4-way handshake. 2820 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels. 2821 * This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver 2822 * to choose from, based on BSS configuration. 2823 */ 2824 struct cfg80211_connect_params { 2825 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 2826 struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint; 2827 const u8 *bssid; 2828 const u8 *bssid_hint; 2829 const u8 *ssid; 2830 size_t ssid_len; 2831 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 2832 const u8 *ie; 2833 size_t ie_len; 2834 bool privacy; 2835 enum nl80211_mfp mfp; 2836 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 2837 const u8 *key; 2838 u8 key_len, key_idx; 2839 u32 flags; 2840 int bg_scan_period; 2841 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 2842 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 2843 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa; 2844 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask; 2845 bool pbss; 2846 struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select; 2847 const u8 *prev_bssid; 2848 const u8 *fils_erp_username; 2849 size_t fils_erp_username_len; 2850 const u8 *fils_erp_realm; 2851 size_t fils_erp_realm_len; 2852 u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num; 2853 const u8 *fils_erp_rrk; 2854 size_t fils_erp_rrk_len; 2855 bool want_1x; 2856 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 2857 }; 2858 2859 /** 2860 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated 2861 * 2862 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that 2863 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call. 2864 * 2865 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated 2866 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm, 2867 * username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated 2868 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated 2869 */ 2870 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed { 2871 UPDATE_ASSOC_IES = BIT(0), 2872 UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO = BIT(1), 2873 UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE = BIT(2), 2874 }; 2875 2876 /** 2877 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values 2878 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed 2879 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed 2880 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed 2881 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed 2882 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed 2883 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled 2884 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed 2885 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed 2886 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum 2887 */ 2888 enum wiphy_params_flags { 2889 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT = 1 << 0, 2890 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG = 1 << 1, 2891 WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD = 1 << 2, 2892 WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD = 1 << 3, 2893 WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS = 1 << 4, 2894 WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK = 1 << 5, 2895 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT = 1 << 6, 2896 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT = 1 << 7, 2897 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM = 1 << 8, 2898 }; 2899 2900 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT 256 2901 2902 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */ 2903 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L 5000 2904 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H 12000 2905 2906 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */ 2907 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD 24000 2908 2909 /** 2910 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association 2911 * 2912 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA 2913 * caching. 2914 * 2915 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL). 2916 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 2917 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key 2918 * derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL. 2919 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on 2920 * the hash algorithm used to generate this. 2921 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS 2922 * cache identifier (may be %NULL). 2923 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets. 2924 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the 2925 * scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be 2926 * %NULL). 2927 * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds 2928 * (dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified. 2929 * The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after 2930 * expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on 2931 * expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK 2932 * used for it expires. 2933 * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of 2934 * PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified. 2935 * Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using 2936 * this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this 2937 * threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires. 2938 */ 2939 struct cfg80211_pmksa { 2940 const u8 *bssid; 2941 const u8 *pmkid; 2942 const u8 *pmk; 2943 size_t pmk_len; 2944 const u8 *ssid; 2945 size_t ssid_len; 2946 const u8 *cache_id; 2947 u32 pmk_lifetime; 2948 u8 pmk_reauth_threshold; 2949 }; 2950 2951 /** 2952 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern 2953 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes, 2954 * one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211 2955 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1 2956 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes) 2957 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes) 2958 * 2959 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of 2960 * memory, free @mask only! 2961 */ 2962 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern { 2963 const u8 *mask, *pattern; 2964 int pattern_len; 2965 int pkt_offset; 2966 }; 2967 2968 /** 2969 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters 2970 * 2971 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation 2972 * @src: source IP address 2973 * @dst: destination IP address 2974 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address 2975 * @src_port: source port 2976 * @dst_port: destination port 2977 * @payload_len: data payload length 2978 * @payload: data payload buffer 2979 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration 2980 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets 2981 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length 2982 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data 2983 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask 2984 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer 2985 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration 2986 */ 2987 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp { 2988 struct socket *sock; 2989 __be32 src, dst; 2990 u16 src_port, dst_port; 2991 u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN]; 2992 int payload_len; 2993 const u8 *payload; 2994 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq; 2995 u32 data_interval; 2996 u32 wake_len; 2997 const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask; 2998 u32 tokens_size; 2999 /* must be last, variable member */ 3000 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok; 3001 }; 3002 3003 /** 3004 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info 3005 * 3006 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device. 3007 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues 3008 * operating as normal during suspend 3009 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected 3010 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet 3011 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern 3012 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 3013 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure 3014 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet 3015 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake 3016 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released 3017 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h. 3018 * NULL if not configured. 3019 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake. 3020 */ 3021 struct cfg80211_wowlan { 3022 bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 3023 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 3024 rfkill_release; 3025 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 3026 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp; 3027 int n_patterns; 3028 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config; 3029 }; 3030 3031 /** 3032 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters 3033 * 3034 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device. 3035 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs. 3036 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence. 3037 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition. 3038 * @patterns: array of packet patterns 3039 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 3040 */ 3041 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules { 3042 int delay; 3043 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition; 3044 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 3045 int n_patterns; 3046 }; 3047 3048 /** 3049 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings 3050 * 3051 * This structure defines coalescing settings. 3052 * @rules: array of coalesce rules 3053 * @n_rules: number of rules 3054 */ 3055 struct cfg80211_coalesce { 3056 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules; 3057 int n_rules; 3058 }; 3059 3060 /** 3061 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match 3062 * 3063 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up 3064 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred. This 3065 * value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels. 3066 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match 3067 * occurred (in MHz) 3068 */ 3069 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match { 3070 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3071 int n_channels; 3072 u32 channels[]; 3073 }; 3074 3075 /** 3076 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information 3077 * 3078 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in 3079 * @matches. This value may be zero if the driver can't provide 3080 * match information. 3081 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about 3082 * the matches that triggered the wake up. 3083 */ 3084 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info { 3085 int n_matches; 3086 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[]; 3087 }; 3088 3089 /** 3090 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report 3091 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected 3092 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet 3093 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure 3094 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet 3095 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake 3096 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released 3097 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern 3098 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data 3099 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length 3100 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any. 3101 * @packet_80211: For pattern match, magic packet and other data 3102 * frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for 3103 * disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which 3104 * it is. 3105 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received 3106 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish 3107 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens 3108 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect 3109 */ 3110 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup { 3111 bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 3112 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 3113 rfkill_release, packet_80211, 3114 tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens; 3115 s32 pattern_idx; 3116 u32 packet_present_len, packet_len; 3117 const void *packet; 3118 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect; 3119 }; 3120 3121 /** 3122 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data 3123 * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes) 3124 * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes) 3125 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes) 3126 * @kek_len: length of kek 3127 * @kck_len length of kck 3128 * @akm: akm (oui, id) 3129 */ 3130 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data { 3131 const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr; 3132 u32 akm; 3133 u8 kek_len, kck_len; 3134 }; 3135 3136 /** 3137 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information 3138 * 3139 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE 3140 * 3141 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value 3142 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs 3143 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets 3144 */ 3145 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params { 3146 u16 md; 3147 const u8 *ie; 3148 size_t ie_len; 3149 }; 3150 3151 /** 3152 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters 3153 * 3154 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame 3155 * 3156 * @chan: channel to use 3157 * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required 3158 * @wait: duration for ROC 3159 * @buf: buffer to transmit 3160 * @len: buffer length 3161 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame 3162 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack 3163 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array 3164 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame 3165 */ 3166 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params { 3167 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 3168 bool offchan; 3169 unsigned int wait; 3170 const u8 *buf; 3171 size_t len; 3172 bool no_cck; 3173 bool dont_wait_for_ack; 3174 int n_csa_offsets; 3175 const u16 *csa_offsets; 3176 }; 3177 3178 /** 3179 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception 3180 * 3181 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition 3182 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs 3183 */ 3184 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception { 3185 u8 dscp; 3186 u8 up; 3187 }; 3188 3189 /** 3190 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority 3191 * 3192 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3193 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3194 */ 3195 struct cfg80211_dscp_range { 3196 u8 low; 3197 u8 high; 3198 }; 3199 3200 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */ 3201 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX 21 3202 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN 16 3203 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \ 3204 (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX) 3205 3206 /** 3207 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information 3208 * 3209 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values 3210 * 3211 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21) 3212 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from 3213 * the user priority DSCP range definition 3214 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority 3215 */ 3216 struct cfg80211_qos_map { 3217 u8 num_des; 3218 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX]; 3219 struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8]; 3220 }; 3221 3222 /** 3223 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration 3224 * 3225 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters 3226 * 3227 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255) 3228 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. 3229 * For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 3230 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 3231 */ 3232 struct cfg80211_nan_conf { 3233 u8 master_pref; 3234 u8 bands; 3235 }; 3236 3237 /** 3238 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN 3239 * configuration 3240 * 3241 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference 3242 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands 3243 */ 3244 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes { 3245 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0), 3246 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1), 3247 }; 3248 3249 /** 3250 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter 3251 * 3252 * @filter: the content of the filter 3253 * @len: the length of the filter 3254 */ 3255 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter { 3256 const u8 *filter; 3257 u8 len; 3258 }; 3259 3260 /** 3261 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function 3262 * 3263 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type 3264 * @service_id: the service ID of the function 3265 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type 3266 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is 3267 * implementation specific. 3268 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted 3269 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active 3270 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up 3271 * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up 3272 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up 3273 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW. 3274 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info 3275 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length 3276 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive 3277 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter 3278 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length 3279 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index 3280 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses 3281 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF 3282 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter 3283 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF. 3284 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters. 3285 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters. 3286 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function. 3287 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier. 3288 */ 3289 struct cfg80211_nan_func { 3290 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 3291 u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN]; 3292 u8 publish_type; 3293 bool close_range; 3294 bool publish_bcast; 3295 bool subscribe_active; 3296 u8 followup_id; 3297 u8 followup_reqid; 3298 struct mac_address followup_dest; 3299 u32 ttl; 3300 const u8 *serv_spec_info; 3301 u8 serv_spec_info_len; 3302 bool srf_include; 3303 const u8 *srf_bf; 3304 u8 srf_bf_len; 3305 u8 srf_bf_idx; 3306 struct mac_address *srf_macs; 3307 int srf_num_macs; 3308 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters; 3309 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters; 3310 u8 num_tx_filters; 3311 u8 num_rx_filters; 3312 u8 instance_id; 3313 u64 cookie; 3314 }; 3315 3316 /** 3317 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration 3318 * 3319 * @aa: authenticator address 3320 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes. 3321 * @pmk: the PMK material 3322 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK 3323 * is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field 3324 * holds PMK-R0. 3325 */ 3326 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf { 3327 const u8 *aa; 3328 u8 pmk_len; 3329 const u8 *pmk; 3330 const u8 *pmk_r0_name; 3331 }; 3332 3333 /** 3334 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication. 3335 * 3336 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces. 3337 * 3338 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant 3339 * for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space). 3340 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has 3341 * to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and 3342 * authentication response command interface. 3343 * @ssid: SSID of the AP. Used by both the authentication request event and 3344 * authentication response command interface. 3345 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the 3346 * authentication request event interface. 3347 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication, 3348 * use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you 3349 * the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication 3350 * response command interface (user space to driver). 3351 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 3352 */ 3353 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params { 3354 enum nl80211_external_auth_action action; 3355 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3356 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3357 unsigned int key_mgmt_suite; 3358 u16 status; 3359 const u8 *pmkid; 3360 }; 3361 3362 /** 3363 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics 3364 * 3365 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to 3366 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 3367 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully 3368 * answered 3369 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were 3370 * successfully answered 3371 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions 3372 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions 3373 * @non_asap_num: number of non-ASAP FTM sessions 3374 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication 3375 * of how much time the responder was busy 3376 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from 3377 * initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with 3378 * the responder 3379 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks 3380 * for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot 3381 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window 3382 */ 3383 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats { 3384 u32 filled; 3385 u32 success_num; 3386 u32 partial_num; 3387 u32 failed_num; 3388 u32 asap_num; 3389 u32 non_asap_num; 3390 u64 total_duration_ms; 3391 u32 unknown_triggers_num; 3392 u32 reschedule_requests_num; 3393 u32 out_of_window_triggers_num; 3394 }; 3395 3396 /** 3397 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result 3398 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is 3399 * %NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise 3400 * reason than just "failure" 3401 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index 3402 * in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported 3403 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted 3404 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked 3405 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY, 3406 * fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible 3407 * by the responder 3408 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated 3409 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated 3410 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated 3411 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present) 3412 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present) 3413 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL) 3414 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL) 3415 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3416 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3417 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response 3418 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame 3419 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg) 3420 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is 3421 * the square root of the variance) 3422 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured 3423 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured 3424 * (must have either this or @rtt_avg) 3425 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance) 3426 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread) 3427 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid 3428 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid 3429 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid 3430 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid 3431 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid 3432 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid 3433 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid 3434 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid 3435 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid 3436 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid 3437 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid 3438 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid 3439 */ 3440 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result { 3441 const u8 *lci; 3442 const u8 *civicloc; 3443 unsigned int lci_len; 3444 unsigned int civicloc_len; 3445 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason; 3446 u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes; 3447 s16 burst_index; 3448 u8 busy_retry_time; 3449 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3450 u8 burst_duration; 3451 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3452 s32 rssi_avg; 3453 s32 rssi_spread; 3454 struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate; 3455 s64 rtt_avg; 3456 s64 rtt_variance; 3457 s64 rtt_spread; 3458 s64 dist_avg; 3459 s64 dist_variance; 3460 s64 dist_spread; 3461 3462 u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1, 3463 num_ftmr_successes_valid:1, 3464 rssi_avg_valid:1, 3465 rssi_spread_valid:1, 3466 tx_rate_valid:1, 3467 rx_rate_valid:1, 3468 rtt_avg_valid:1, 3469 rtt_variance_valid:1, 3470 rtt_spread_valid:1, 3471 dist_avg_valid:1, 3472 dist_variance_valid:1, 3473 dist_spread_valid:1; 3474 }; 3475 3476 /** 3477 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result 3478 * @addr: address of the peer 3479 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the 3480 * measurement was made) 3481 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time 3482 * @status: status of the measurement 3483 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not 3484 * reporting partial results always set this flag 3485 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid 3486 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting 3487 * one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and 3488 * they're all aggregated for userspace. 3489 */ 3490 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result { 3491 u64 host_time, ap_tsf; 3492 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status; 3493 3494 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 3495 3496 u8 final:1, 3497 ap_tsf_valid:1; 3498 3499 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type; 3500 3501 union { 3502 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm; 3503 }; 3504 }; 3505 3506 /** 3507 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data 3508 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested 3509 * @preamble: frame preamble to use 3510 * @burst_period: burst period to use 3511 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode 3512 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent 3513 * @burst_duration: burst duration 3514 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst 3515 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request 3516 * @request_lci: request LCI information 3517 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information 3518 * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement 3519 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3520 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3521 * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement 3522 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3523 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3524 * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either 3525 * @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set. 3526 * 3527 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation. 3528 */ 3529 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer { 3530 enum nl80211_preamble preamble; 3531 u16 burst_period; 3532 u8 requested:1, 3533 asap:1, 3534 request_lci:1, 3535 request_civicloc:1, 3536 trigger_based:1, 3537 non_trigger_based:1, 3538 lmr_feedback:1; 3539 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3540 u8 burst_duration; 3541 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3542 u8 ftmr_retries; 3543 }; 3544 3545 /** 3546 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request 3547 * @addr: MAC address 3548 * @chandef: channel to use 3549 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF 3550 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer 3551 */ 3552 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer { 3553 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 3554 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 3555 u8 report_ap_tsf:1; 3556 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm; 3557 }; 3558 3559 /** 3560 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request 3561 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211 3562 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211 3563 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting, 3564 * not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211 3565 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request 3566 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that 3567 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 3568 * be taken from the @mac_addr 3569 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request 3570 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if 3571 * zero it means there's no timeout 3572 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with 3573 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data 3574 */ 3575 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request { 3576 u64 cookie; 3577 void *drv_data; 3578 u32 n_peers; 3579 u32 nl_portid; 3580 3581 u32 timeout; 3582 3583 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3584 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3585 3586 struct list_head list; 3587 3588 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[]; 3589 }; 3590 3591 /** 3592 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information 3593 * 3594 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE 3595 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space. 3596 * 3597 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces. 3598 * 3599 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing 3600 * has to be done. 3601 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info 3602 * processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space 3603 * cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for 3604 * OWE update request command interface (user space to driver). 3605 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are 3606 * the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and 3607 * the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface. 3608 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets. 3609 */ 3610 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info { 3611 u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3612 u16 status; 3613 const u8 *ie; 3614 size_t ie_len; 3615 }; 3616 3617 /** 3618 * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data 3619 * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 3620 * for the entire device 3621 * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 3622 * for the given interface 3623 * @global_mcast_rx: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes 3624 * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface 3625 * for these subtypes 3626 */ 3627 struct mgmt_frame_regs { 3628 u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes; 3629 u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes; 3630 }; 3631 3632 /** 3633 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration 3634 * 3635 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks 3636 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces. 3637 * 3638 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0 3639 * on success or a negative error code. 3640 * 3641 * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be 3642 * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied 3643 * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering, 3644 * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers. 3645 * 3646 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will 3647 * be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are 3648 * configured for the device. 3649 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed 3650 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback 3651 * to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from 3652 * the device. 3653 * 3654 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name, 3655 * must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create 3656 * the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct 3657 * wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must 3658 * also set the address member in the wdev. 3659 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 3660 * 3661 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface 3662 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 3663 * 3664 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface, 3665 * keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated. 3666 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 3667 * 3668 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL 3669 * when adding a group key. 3670 * 3671 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters. 3672 * @mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group 3673 * key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid 3674 * after it returns. This function should return an error if it is 3675 * not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist. 3676 * 3677 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key) 3678 * and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. 3679 * 3680 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface 3681 * 3682 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface 3683 * 3684 * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface 3685 * 3686 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver 3687 * 3688 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters. 3689 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode 3690 * interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started. 3691 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing. 3692 * 3693 * @add_station: Add a new station. 3694 * @del_station: Remove a station 3695 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much 3696 * validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags 3697 * might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check 3698 * them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call 3699 * cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information. 3700 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac 3701 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3702 * 3703 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path 3704 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path 3705 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path 3706 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters 3707 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3708 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters 3709 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 3710 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters 3711 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3712 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network 3713 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3714 * 3715 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration 3716 * 3717 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh. 3718 * The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to 3719 * set, and which to leave alone. 3720 * 3721 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS. 3722 * 3723 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters 3724 * 3725 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas, 3726 * as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to 3727 * join the mesh instead. 3728 * 3729 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other 3730 * interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration. 3731 * If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should 3732 * be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active. 3733 * 3734 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given 3735 * the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done(). 3736 * For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside 3737 * the scan/scan_done bracket too. 3738 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall 3739 * indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done(). 3740 * 3741 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer 3742 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3743 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer 3744 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3745 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer 3746 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3747 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer 3748 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3749 * 3750 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected, 3751 * call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code 3752 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call 3753 * cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code 3754 * from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code 3755 * was received. 3756 * The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the 3757 * other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated 3758 * by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches 3759 * the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request 3760 * frame instead of Association Request frame. 3761 * The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a 3762 * specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid 3763 * parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an 3764 * indication of requesting reassociation. 3765 * In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming 3766 * cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to 3767 * cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3768 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a 3769 * BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for 3770 * subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the 3771 * Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not 3772 * request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current 3773 * BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in 3774 * changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed. 3775 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3776 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if 3777 * connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in 3778 * case connection was already established (invoked with the 3779 * wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout(). 3780 * 3781 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call 3782 * cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due 3783 * to a merge. 3784 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3785 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS. 3786 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3787 * 3788 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or 3789 * MESH mode) 3790 * 3791 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed; 3792 * @changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values 3793 * have changed. The actual parameter values are available in 3794 * struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed. 3795 * 3796 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters, 3797 * the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The 3798 * wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will 3799 * always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power 3800 * (as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.) 3801 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable; 3802 * return 0 if successful 3803 * 3804 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting 3805 * functions to adjust rfkill hw state 3806 * 3807 * @dump_survey: get site survey information. 3808 * 3809 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified 3810 * channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel 3811 * operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is 3812 * ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event 3813 * notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel(). 3814 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation. 3815 * This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on 3816 * the duration value. 3817 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame. 3818 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management 3819 * frame on another channel 3820 * 3821 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL 3822 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be 3823 * used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally, 3824 * return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the 3825 * dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data 3826 * was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present 3827 * and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA. 3828 * 3829 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration 3830 * 3831 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac 3832 * devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association 3833 * RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs. 3834 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID. 3835 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs. 3836 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1 3837 * allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value. 3838 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold. 3839 * After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating 3840 * the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may 3841 * need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being 3842 * disabled.) 3843 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the 3844 * connection quality monitor. An event is to be sent only when the 3845 * signal level is found to be outside the two values. The driver should 3846 * set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented. 3847 * If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config. 3848 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error 3849 * thresholds. 3850 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan. 3851 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with 3852 * given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready 3853 * for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be 3854 * called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case. 3855 * The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested 3856 * stop (when this method returns 0). 3857 * 3858 * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame 3859 * registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep. 3860 * 3861 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. 3862 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may 3863 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL 3864 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). 3865 * 3866 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). 3867 * 3868 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame. 3869 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup). 3870 * 3871 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it 3872 * later passes to cfg80211_probe_status(). 3873 * 3874 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs. 3875 * 3876 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface. 3877 * For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single 3878 * current monitoring channel. 3879 * 3880 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device. 3881 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device. 3882 * 3883 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode. 3884 * Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations 3885 * and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver 3886 * this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL 3887 * when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which 3888 * advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback. 3889 * 3890 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver. 3891 * 3892 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC 3893 * was finished on another phy. 3894 * 3895 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the 3896 * driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be 3897 * used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames. 3898 * 3899 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability 3900 * for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the 3901 * driver can take the most appropriate actions. 3902 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link 3903 * reliability. This operation can not fail. 3904 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters. 3905 * 3906 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is 3907 * responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is 3908 * inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later 3909 * with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept 3910 * everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them 3911 * as soon as possible. 3912 * 3913 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver 3914 * 3915 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the 3916 * given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width 3917 * changes during the lifetime of the BSS. 3918 * 3919 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device 3920 * with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by 3921 * userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into 3922 * account. 3923 * If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure 3924 * the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return 3925 * success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake 3926 * with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later 3927 * rejected) 3928 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS 3929 * 3930 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters 3931 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3932 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network 3933 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3934 * 3935 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver 3936 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations 3937 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. 3938 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both 3939 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. 3940 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface. 3941 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface. 3942 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure. 3943 * On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and 3944 * it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver 3945 * should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling 3946 * cfg80211_free_nan_func(). 3947 * On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the 3948 * provided @nan_func. 3949 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function. 3950 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must 3951 * be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes); 3952 * All other parameters must be ignored. 3953 * 3954 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS 3955 * 3956 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this 3957 * function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise. 3958 * 3959 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake. 3960 * If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect 3961 * upon which the driver should clear it. 3962 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3963 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator. 3964 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 3965 * 3966 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from 3967 * user space 3968 * 3969 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL). The noencrypt parameter 3970 * tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted. 3971 * 3972 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. 3973 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. 3974 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) 3975 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement 3976 * 3977 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME 3978 * but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated 3979 * DH IE through this interface. 3980 * 3981 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame 3982 * and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm. 3983 * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific 3984 * This callback may sleep. 3985 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the 3986 * given TIDs. This callback may sleep. 3987 * 3988 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings. 3989 */ 3990 struct cfg80211_ops { 3991 int (*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow); 3992 int (*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 3993 void (*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled); 3994 3995 struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 3996 const char *name, 3997 unsigned char name_assign_type, 3998 enum nl80211_iftype type, 3999 struct vif_params *params); 4000 int (*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4001 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4002 int (*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4003 struct net_device *dev, 4004 enum nl80211_iftype type, 4005 struct vif_params *params); 4006 4007 int (*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4008 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr, 4009 struct key_params *params); 4010 int (*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4011 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr, 4012 void *cookie, 4013 void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*)); 4014 int (*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4015 u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr); 4016 int (*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4017 struct net_device *netdev, 4018 u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast); 4019 int (*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4020 struct net_device *netdev, 4021 u8 key_index); 4022 int (*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4023 struct net_device *netdev, 4024 u8 key_index); 4025 4026 int (*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4027 struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings); 4028 int (*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4029 struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info); 4030 int (*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4031 4032 4033 int (*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4034 const u8 *mac, 4035 struct station_parameters *params); 4036 int (*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4037 struct station_del_parameters *params); 4038 int (*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4039 const u8 *mac, 4040 struct station_parameters *params); 4041 int (*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4042 const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 4043 int (*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4044 int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 4045 4046 int (*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4047 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 4048 int (*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4049 const u8 *dst); 4050 int (*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4051 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 4052 int (*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4053 u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4054 int (*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4055 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, 4056 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4057 int (*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4058 u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4059 int (*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4060 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, 4061 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4062 int (*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4063 struct net_device *dev, 4064 struct mesh_config *conf); 4065 int (*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4066 struct net_device *dev, u32 mask, 4067 const struct mesh_config *nconf); 4068 int (*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4069 const struct mesh_config *conf, 4070 const struct mesh_setup *setup); 4071 int (*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4072 4073 int (*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4074 struct ocb_setup *setup); 4075 int (*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4076 4077 int (*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4078 struct bss_parameters *params); 4079 4080 int (*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4081 struct ieee80211_txq_params *params); 4082 4083 int (*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4084 struct net_device *dev, 4085 struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 4086 4087 int (*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4088 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4089 4090 int (*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4091 struct cfg80211_scan_request *request); 4092 void (*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4093 4094 int (*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4095 struct cfg80211_auth_request *req); 4096 int (*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4097 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req); 4098 int (*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4099 struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req); 4100 int (*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4101 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req); 4102 4103 int (*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4104 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme); 4105 int (*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4106 struct net_device *dev, 4107 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme, 4108 u32 changed); 4109 int (*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4110 u16 reason_code); 4111 4112 int (*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4113 struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params); 4114 int (*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4115 4116 int (*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4117 int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]); 4118 4119 int (*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed); 4120 4121 int (*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4122 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm); 4123 int (*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4124 int *dbm); 4125 4126 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 4127 4128 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 4129 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4130 void *data, int len); 4131 int (*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb, 4132 struct netlink_callback *cb, 4133 void *data, int len); 4134 #endif 4135 4136 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4137 struct net_device *dev, 4138 const u8 *peer, 4139 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); 4140 4141 int (*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4142 int idx, struct survey_info *info); 4143 4144 int (*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4145 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4146 int (*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4147 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4148 int (*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev); 4149 4150 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4151 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4152 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 4153 unsigned int duration, 4154 u64 *cookie); 4155 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4156 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4157 u64 cookie); 4158 4159 int (*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4160 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params, 4161 u64 *cookie); 4162 int (*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4163 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4164 u64 cookie); 4165 4166 int (*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4167 bool enabled, int timeout); 4168 4169 int (*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4170 struct net_device *dev, 4171 s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst); 4172 4173 int (*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4174 struct net_device *dev, 4175 s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high); 4176 4177 int (*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4178 struct net_device *dev, 4179 u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl); 4180 4181 void (*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4182 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4183 struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd); 4184 4185 int (*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); 4186 int (*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); 4187 4188 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4189 struct net_device *dev, 4190 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request); 4191 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4192 u64 reqid); 4193 4194 int (*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4195 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); 4196 4197 int (*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4198 const u8 *peer, u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, 4199 u16 status_code, u32 peer_capability, 4200 bool initiator, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4201 int (*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4202 const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper); 4203 4204 int (*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4205 const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie); 4206 4207 int (*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4208 struct net_device *dev, 4209 u16 noack_map); 4210 4211 int (*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4212 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4213 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4214 4215 int (*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4216 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4217 void (*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4218 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4219 4220 int (*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4221 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params); 4222 4223 int (*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4224 struct net_device *dev, 4225 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 4226 u32 cac_time_ms); 4227 void (*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4228 struct net_device *dev); 4229 int (*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4230 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie); 4231 int (*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4232 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4233 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol, 4234 u16 duration); 4235 void (*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4236 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4237 int (*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4238 struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce); 4239 4240 int (*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4241 struct net_device *dev, 4242 struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params); 4243 4244 int (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4245 struct net_device *dev, 4246 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 4247 4248 int (*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4249 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4250 4251 int (*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4252 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio, 4253 u16 admitted_time); 4254 int (*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4255 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer); 4256 4257 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4258 struct net_device *dev, 4259 const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class, 4260 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4261 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4262 struct net_device *dev, 4263 const u8 *addr); 4264 int (*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4265 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); 4266 void (*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4267 int (*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4268 struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); 4269 void (*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4270 u64 cookie); 4271 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4272 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4273 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, 4274 u32 changes); 4275 4276 int (*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4277 struct net_device *dev, 4278 const bool enabled); 4279 4280 int (*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4281 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4282 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats); 4283 4284 int (*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4285 const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf); 4286 int (*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4287 const u8 *aa); 4288 int (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4289 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params); 4290 4291 int (*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4292 struct net_device *dev, 4293 const u8 *buf, size_t len, 4294 const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto, 4295 const bool noencrypt, 4296 u64 *cookie); 4297 4298 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4299 struct net_device *dev, 4300 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); 4301 4302 int (*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4303 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4304 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4305 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4306 int (*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4307 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info); 4308 int (*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4309 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4310 int (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4311 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); 4312 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4313 const u8 *peer, u8 tids); 4314 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4315 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar); 4316 }; 4317 4318 /* 4319 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures 4320 * and registration/helper functions 4321 */ 4322 4323 /** 4324 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags 4325 * 4326 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split 4327 * into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB. 4328 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this 4329 * wiphy at all 4330 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled 4331 * by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default 4332 * on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good 4333 * reason to override the default 4334 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station 4335 * on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of 4336 * supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype. 4337 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station 4338 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the 4339 * control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the 4340 * control_port_no_encrypt flag. 4341 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN. 4342 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing 4343 * auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH. 4344 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the 4345 * firmware. 4346 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP. 4347 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation. 4348 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z) 4349 * link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and 4350 * teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT 4351 * command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be 4352 * used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation. 4353 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME 4354 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes 4355 * when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling 4356 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(). 4357 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device 4358 * responds to probe-requests in hardware. 4359 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX. 4360 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call. 4361 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels. 4362 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in 4363 * beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...). 4364 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP: The device supports static WEP key installation 4365 * before connection. 4366 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys 4367 */ 4368 enum wiphy_flags { 4369 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK = BIT(0), 4370 /* use hole at 1 */ 4371 WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ = BIT(2), 4372 WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK = BIT(3), 4373 WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT = BIT(4), 4374 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP = BIT(5), 4375 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION = BIT(6), 4376 WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL = BIT(7), 4377 WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN = BIT(8), 4378 WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH = BIT(10), 4379 /* use hole at 11 */ 4380 /* use hole at 12 */ 4381 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM = BIT(13), 4382 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD = BIT(14), 4383 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS = BIT(15), 4384 WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP = BIT(16), 4385 WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME = BIT(17), 4386 WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS = BIT(18), 4387 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD = BIT(19), 4388 WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX = BIT(20), 4389 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL = BIT(21), 4390 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ = BIT(22), 4391 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = BIT(23), 4392 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP = BIT(24), 4393 }; 4394 4395 /** 4396 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types 4397 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types 4398 * @types: interface types (bits) 4399 */ 4400 struct ieee80211_iface_limit { 4401 u16 max; 4402 u16 types; 4403 }; 4404 4405 /** 4406 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination 4407 * 4408 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface 4409 * combinations it supports concurrently. 4410 * 4411 * Examples: 4412 * 4413 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total: 4414 * 4415 * .. code-block:: c 4416 * 4417 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = { 4418 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 4419 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP}, }, 4420 * }; 4421 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = { 4422 * .limits = limits1, 4423 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1), 4424 * .max_interfaces = 2, 4425 * .beacon_int_infra_match = true, 4426 * }; 4427 * 4428 * 4429 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total: 4430 * 4431 * .. code-block:: c 4432 * 4433 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = { 4434 * { .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) | 4435 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), }, 4436 * }; 4437 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = { 4438 * .limits = limits2, 4439 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2), 4440 * .max_interfaces = 8, 4441 * .num_different_channels = 1, 4442 * }; 4443 * 4444 * 4445 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total. 4446 * 4447 * This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections. 4448 * 4449 * .. code-block:: c 4450 * 4451 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = { 4452 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 4453 * { .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) | 4454 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), }, 4455 * }; 4456 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = { 4457 * .limits = limits3, 4458 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3), 4459 * .max_interfaces = 4, 4460 * .num_different_channels = 2, 4461 * }; 4462 * 4463 */ 4464 struct ieee80211_iface_combination { 4465 /** 4466 * @limits: 4467 * limits for the given interface types 4468 */ 4469 const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits; 4470 4471 /** 4472 * @num_different_channels: 4473 * can use up to this many different channels 4474 */ 4475 u32 num_different_channels; 4476 4477 /** 4478 * @max_interfaces: 4479 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group 4480 */ 4481 u16 max_interfaces; 4482 4483 /** 4484 * @n_limits: 4485 * number of limitations 4486 */ 4487 u8 n_limits; 4488 4489 /** 4490 * @beacon_int_infra_match: 4491 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure 4492 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases. 4493 */ 4494 bool beacon_int_infra_match; 4495 4496 /** 4497 * @radar_detect_widths: 4498 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection 4499 */ 4500 u8 radar_detect_widths; 4501 4502 /** 4503 * @radar_detect_regions: 4504 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection 4505 */ 4506 u8 radar_detect_regions; 4507 4508 /** 4509 * @beacon_int_min_gcd: 4510 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals. 4511 * 4512 * = 0 4513 * all beacon intervals for different interface must be same. 4514 * > 0 4515 * any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND 4516 * GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this 4517 * combination must be greater or equal to this value. 4518 */ 4519 u32 beacon_int_min_gcd; 4520 }; 4521 4522 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes { 4523 u16 tx, rx; 4524 }; 4525 4526 /** 4527 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags 4528 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any" 4529 * trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and 4530 * wakes up the host on any activity, for example a 4531 * received packet that passed filtering; note that the 4532 * packet should be preserved in that case 4533 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet 4534 * (see nl80211.h) 4535 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect 4536 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep 4537 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure 4538 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request 4539 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure 4540 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release 4541 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection 4542 */ 4543 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags { 4544 WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY = BIT(0), 4545 WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT = BIT(1), 4546 WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT = BIT(2), 4547 WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY = BIT(3), 4548 WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE = BIT(4), 4549 WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ = BIT(5), 4550 WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE = BIT(6), 4551 WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE = BIT(7), 4552 WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT = BIT(8), 4553 }; 4554 4555 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support { 4556 const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok; 4557 u32 data_payload_max; 4558 u32 data_interval_max; 4559 u32 wake_payload_max; 4560 bool seq; 4561 }; 4562 4563 /** 4564 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data 4565 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags 4566 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns 4567 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 4568 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 4569 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 4570 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 4571 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect, 4572 * similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for 4573 * scheduled scans. 4574 * See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more 4575 * details. 4576 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information 4577 */ 4578 struct wiphy_wowlan_support { 4579 u32 flags; 4580 int n_patterns; 4581 int pattern_max_len; 4582 int pattern_min_len; 4583 int max_pkt_offset; 4584 int max_nd_match_sets; 4585 const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp; 4586 }; 4587 4588 /** 4589 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data 4590 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules 4591 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs 4592 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule 4593 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 4594 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 4595 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 4596 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 4597 */ 4598 struct wiphy_coalesce_support { 4599 int n_rules; 4600 int max_delay; 4601 int n_patterns; 4602 int pattern_max_len; 4603 int pattern_min_len; 4604 int max_pkt_offset; 4605 }; 4606 4607 /** 4608 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands 4609 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev 4610 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev 4611 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running 4612 * (must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV) 4613 */ 4614 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags { 4615 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0), 4616 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1), 4617 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2), 4618 }; 4619 4620 /** 4621 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags 4622 * 4623 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed 4624 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed 4625 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed 4626 * 4627 */ 4628 enum wiphy_opmode_flag { 4629 STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), 4630 STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED = BIT(1), 4631 STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED = BIT(2), 4632 }; 4633 4634 /** 4635 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information 4636 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag 4637 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station 4638 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station 4639 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station 4640 */ 4641 4642 struct sta_opmode_info { 4643 u32 changed; 4644 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 4645 enum nl80211_chan_width bw; 4646 u8 rx_nss; 4647 }; 4648 4649 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA)) 4650 4651 /** 4652 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition 4653 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211 4654 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags 4655 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the 4656 * flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data 4657 * pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all 4658 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The 4659 * @storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple 4660 * dumpit calls. 4661 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA. 4662 * Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the 4663 * attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command). 4664 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy 4665 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and 4666 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others 4667 * are used with dump requests. 4668 */ 4669 struct wiphy_vendor_command { 4670 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info; 4671 u32 flags; 4672 int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4673 const void *data, int data_len); 4674 int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4675 struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len, 4676 unsigned long *storage); 4677 const struct nla_policy *policy; 4678 unsigned int maxattr; 4679 }; 4680 4681 /** 4682 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type 4683 * @iftype: interface type 4684 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 4685 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the 4686 * 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are 4687 * in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std 4688 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. 4689 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 4690 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 4691 */ 4692 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab { 4693 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 4694 const u8 *extended_capabilities; 4695 const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask; 4696 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 4697 }; 4698 4699 /** 4700 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities 4701 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement 4702 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement 4703 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement 4704 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported 4705 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported 4706 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported 4707 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data 4708 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data 4709 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble) 4710 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width) 4711 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported 4712 * (set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily 4713 * forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick) 4714 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if 4715 * not limited) 4716 * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported 4717 * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported 4718 */ 4719 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities { 4720 unsigned int max_peers; 4721 u8 report_ap_tsf:1, 4722 randomize_mac_addr:1; 4723 4724 struct { 4725 u32 preambles; 4726 u32 bandwidths; 4727 s8 max_bursts_exponent; 4728 u8 max_ftms_per_burst; 4729 u8 supported:1, 4730 asap:1, 4731 non_asap:1, 4732 request_lci:1, 4733 request_civicloc:1, 4734 trigger_based:1, 4735 non_trigger_based:1; 4736 } ftm; 4737 }; 4738 4739 /** 4740 * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm 4741 * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the 4742 * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites. 4743 * 4744 * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types 4745 * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites 4746 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 4747 */ 4748 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites { 4749 u16 iftypes_mask; 4750 const u32 *akm_suites; 4751 int n_akm_suites; 4752 }; 4753 4754 /** 4755 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description 4756 * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device 4757 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback, 4758 * note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory() 4759 * the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL 4760 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via 4761 * the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver 4762 * on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future 4763 * regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers. 4764 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss. 4765 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites 4766 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites 4767 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if 4768 * the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in 4769 * iftype_akm_suites. 4770 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 4771 * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type. 4772 * Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot 4773 * overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all 4774 * instances of iftype_akm_suites). 4775 * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm 4776 * suites are specified separately. 4777 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit) 4778 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit) 4779 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold); 4780 * -1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used 4781 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled 4782 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in 4783 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device 4784 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking, 4785 * set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last 4786 * four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual 4787 * variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with 4788 * interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up. 4789 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses. 4790 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer 4791 * to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used 4792 * by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to 4793 * all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle 4794 * the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses. 4795 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against 4796 * unregister hardware 4797 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>). 4798 * It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames 4799 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in 4800 * /sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev() 4801 * (see below). 4802 * @wext: wireless extension handlers 4803 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter) 4804 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy, 4805 * must be set by driver 4806 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not 4807 * list single interface types. 4808 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array. 4809 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not 4810 * subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW. 4811 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags 4812 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see 4813 * &enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags 4814 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags. 4815 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see 4816 * &enum nl80211_ext_feature_index. 4817 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it, 4818 * this variable determines its size 4819 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in 4820 * any given scan 4821 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that 4822 * the device can run concurrently. 4823 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan 4824 * for in any given scheduled scan 4825 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle 4826 * when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not 4827 * supported. 4828 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can 4829 * add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not 4830 * include fixed IEs like supported rates 4831 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled 4832 * scans 4833 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number 4834 * of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device. 4835 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a 4836 * single scan plan supported by the device. 4837 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single 4838 * scan plan supported by the device. 4839 * @coverage_class: current coverage class 4840 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting 4841 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting 4842 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device 4843 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary 4844 * wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers 4845 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device 4846 * 4847 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or 4848 * transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface 4849 * type 4850 * 4851 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 4852 * configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 4853 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set. 4854 * 4855 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 4856 * configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 4857 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set. 4858 * 4859 * @probe_resp_offload: 4860 * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading. 4861 * See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid 4862 * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set. 4863 * 4864 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation 4865 * may request, if implemented. 4866 * 4867 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information 4868 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be 4869 * used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed 4870 * to the suspend() operation instead. 4871 * 4872 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features. 4873 * @ht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden. 4874 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 4875 * @vht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden. 4876 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 4877 * 4878 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must 4879 * not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection. 4880 * 4881 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device 4882 * supports for ACL. 4883 * 4884 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 4885 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are 4886 * the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") 4887 * and are in the same format as in the information element. See 4888 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default 4889 * extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified 4890 * for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab. 4891 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 4892 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 4893 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type 4894 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended 4895 * capabilities are specified separately. 4896 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information 4897 * 4898 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware 4899 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands 4900 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware 4901 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events 4902 * 4903 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode 4904 * (including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The 4905 * driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in 4906 * some cases, but may not always reach. 4907 * 4908 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons 4909 * and probe responses. This value should be set if the driver 4910 * wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means 4911 * infinite. 4912 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported 4913 * by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the 4914 * attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr. 4915 * 4916 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a 4917 * bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. For instance, for 4918 * NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 4919 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 4920 * 4921 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit 4922 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit 4923 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum 4924 * 4925 * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using 4926 * wake_tx_queue 4927 * 4928 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP 4929 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not 4930 * HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues. 4931 * @support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect. 4932 * 4933 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities 4934 * 4935 * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the 4936 * device has 4937 * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 4938 * supported by the driver for each vif 4939 * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 4940 * supported by the driver for each peer 4941 * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for 4942 * long/short retry configuration 4943 * 4944 * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for 4945 * configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and 4946 * %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes 4947 * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities 4948 */ 4949 struct wiphy { 4950 struct mutex mtx; 4951 4952 /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */ 4953 4954 u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN]; 4955 u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN]; 4956 4957 struct mac_address *addresses; 4958 4959 const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes; 4960 4961 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations; 4962 int n_iface_combinations; 4963 u16 software_iftypes; 4964 4965 u16 n_addresses; 4966 4967 /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */ 4968 u16 interface_modes; 4969 4970 u16 max_acl_mac_addrs; 4971 4972 u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features; 4973 u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)]; 4974 4975 u32 ap_sme_capa; 4976 4977 enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type; 4978 4979 int bss_priv_size; 4980 u8 max_scan_ssids; 4981 u8 max_sched_scan_reqs; 4982 u8 max_sched_scan_ssids; 4983 u8 max_match_sets; 4984 u16 max_scan_ie_len; 4985 u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len; 4986 u32 max_sched_scan_plans; 4987 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval; 4988 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations; 4989 4990 int n_cipher_suites; 4991 const u32 *cipher_suites; 4992 4993 int n_akm_suites; 4994 const u32 *akm_suites; 4995 4996 const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites; 4997 unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites; 4998 4999 u8 retry_short; 5000 u8 retry_long; 5001 u32 frag_threshold; 5002 u32 rts_threshold; 5003 u8 coverage_class; 5004 5005 char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN]; 5006 u32 hw_version; 5007 5008 #ifdef CONFIG_PM 5009 const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan; 5010 struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config; 5011 #endif 5012 5013 u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration; 5014 5015 u8 max_num_pmkids; 5016 5017 u32 available_antennas_tx; 5018 u32 available_antennas_rx; 5019 5020 u32 probe_resp_offload; 5021 5022 const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask; 5023 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 5024 5025 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab; 5026 unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab; 5027 5028 const void *privid; 5029 5030 struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 5031 5032 void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5033 struct regulatory_request *request); 5034 5035 /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */ 5036 5037 const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd; 5038 5039 struct device dev; 5040 5041 bool registered; 5042 5043 struct dentry *debugfsdir; 5044 5045 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask; 5046 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask; 5047 5048 struct list_head wdev_list; 5049 5050 possible_net_t _net; 5051 5052 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 5053 const struct iw_handler_def *wext; 5054 #endif 5055 5056 const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce; 5057 5058 const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands; 5059 const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events; 5060 int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events; 5061 5062 u16 max_ap_assoc_sta; 5063 5064 u8 max_num_csa_counters; 5065 5066 u32 bss_select_support; 5067 5068 u8 nan_supported_bands; 5069 5070 u32 txq_limit; 5071 u32 txq_memory_limit; 5072 u32 txq_quantum; 5073 5074 unsigned long tx_queue_len; 5075 5076 u8 support_mbssid:1, 5077 support_only_he_mbssid:1; 5078 5079 const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa; 5080 5081 struct { 5082 u64 peer, vif; 5083 u8 max_retry; 5084 } tid_config_support; 5085 5086 u8 max_data_retry_count; 5087 5088 const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa; 5089 5090 char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN); 5091 }; 5092 5093 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5094 { 5095 return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net); 5096 } 5097 5098 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net) 5099 { 5100 write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net); 5101 } 5102 5103 /** 5104 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy 5105 * 5106 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return 5107 * Return: The priv of @wiphy. 5108 */ 5109 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5110 { 5111 BUG_ON(!wiphy); 5112 return &wiphy->priv; 5113 } 5114 5115 /** 5116 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv 5117 * 5118 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv 5119 * Return: The wiphy of @priv. 5120 */ 5121 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv) 5122 { 5123 BUG_ON(!priv); 5124 return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv); 5125 } 5126 5127 /** 5128 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy 5129 * 5130 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind 5131 * @dev: The device to parent it to 5132 */ 5133 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev) 5134 { 5135 wiphy->dev.parent = dev; 5136 } 5137 5138 /** 5139 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer 5140 * 5141 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up 5142 * Return: The dev of @wiphy. 5143 */ 5144 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5145 { 5146 return wiphy->dev.parent; 5147 } 5148 5149 /** 5150 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name 5151 * 5152 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return 5153 * Return: The name of @wiphy. 5154 */ 5155 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy) 5156 { 5157 return dev_name(&wiphy->dev); 5158 } 5159 5160 /** 5161 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5162 * 5163 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5164 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5165 * @requested_name: Request a particular name. 5166 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming. 5167 * 5168 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5169 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5170 * 5171 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5172 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5173 */ 5174 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv, 5175 const char *requested_name); 5176 5177 /** 5178 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5179 * 5180 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5181 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5182 * 5183 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5184 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5185 * 5186 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5187 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5188 */ 5189 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, 5190 int sizeof_priv) 5191 { 5192 return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL); 5193 } 5194 5195 /** 5196 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211 5197 * 5198 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register. 5199 * 5200 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code. 5201 */ 5202 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5203 5204 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */ 5205 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx) 5206 5207 /** 5208 * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking 5209 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on 5210 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing 5211 * 5212 * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock() 5213 * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference(). 5214 */ 5215 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p) \ 5216 rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) 5217 5218 /** 5219 * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx 5220 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on 5221 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing 5222 * 5223 * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the 5224 * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates. 5225 */ 5226 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p) \ 5227 rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) 5228 5229 /** 5230 * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy 5231 * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from 5232 */ 5233 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5234 5235 /** 5236 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211 5237 * 5238 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister. 5239 * 5240 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv 5241 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding 5242 * request that is being handled. 5243 */ 5244 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5245 5246 /** 5247 * wiphy_free - free wiphy 5248 * 5249 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free 5250 */ 5251 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5252 5253 /* internal structs */ 5254 struct cfg80211_conn; 5255 struct cfg80211_internal_bss; 5256 struct cfg80211_cached_keys; 5257 struct cfg80211_cqm_config; 5258 5259 /** 5260 * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy 5261 * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock 5262 * 5263 * This is mostly exposed so it can be done around registering and 5264 * unregistering netdevs that aren't created through cfg80211 calls, 5265 * since that requires locking in cfg80211 when the notifiers is 5266 * called, but that cannot differentiate which way it's called. 5267 * 5268 * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked. 5269 */ 5270 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5271 __acquires(&wiphy->mtx) 5272 { 5273 mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx); 5274 __acquire(&wiphy->mtx); 5275 } 5276 5277 /** 5278 * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again 5279 * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock 5280 */ 5281 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5282 __releases(&wiphy->mtx) 5283 { 5284 __release(&wiphy->mtx); 5285 mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx); 5286 } 5287 5288 /** 5289 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state 5290 * 5291 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver 5292 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this 5293 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.) 5294 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will 5295 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device, 5296 * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or 5297 * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops 5298 * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.) 5299 * 5300 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver 5301 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as 5302 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be 5303 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it. 5304 * 5305 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description 5306 * @iftype: interface type 5307 * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211 5308 * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock 5309 * for the notifier 5310 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces 5311 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL 5312 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this 5313 * wireless device if it has no netdev 5314 * @current_bss: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5315 * @chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to track 5316 * the user-set channel definition. 5317 * @preset_chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to 5318 * track the channel to be used for AP later 5319 * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5320 * @ssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5321 * @ssid_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5322 * @mesh_id_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5323 * @mesh_id_up_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 5324 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code 5325 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling 5326 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data 5327 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data 5328 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association 5329 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements 5330 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID 5331 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID 5332 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index 5333 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index 5334 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation 5335 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity 5336 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be 5337 * set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the 5338 * netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update 5339 * by cfg80211 on change_interface 5340 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames 5341 * @mgmt_registrations_lock: lock for the list 5342 * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated, 5343 * need to propagate the update to the driver 5344 * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers 5345 * and some API functions require it held 5346 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting 5347 * beacons, 0 when not valid 5348 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL 5349 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g. 5350 * the P2P Device. 5351 * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started 5352 * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 5353 * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms 5354 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled 5355 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout 5356 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application 5357 * registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode) 5358 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data 5359 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established 5360 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type 5361 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID 5362 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work 5363 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect 5364 * @ibss_fixed: (private) IBSS is using fixed BSSID 5365 * @ibss_dfs_possible: (private) IBSS may change to a DFS channel 5366 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing 5367 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list 5368 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID 5369 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away 5370 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state 5371 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests 5372 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock 5373 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work 5374 * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last 5375 * unprotected beacon report 5376 */ 5377 struct wireless_dev { 5378 struct wiphy *wiphy; 5379 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 5380 5381 /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */ 5382 struct list_head list; 5383 struct net_device *netdev; 5384 5385 u32 identifier; 5386 5387 struct list_head mgmt_registrations; 5388 spinlock_t mgmt_registrations_lock; 5389 u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1; 5390 5391 struct mutex mtx; 5392 5393 bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering; 5394 5395 u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16)); 5396 5397 /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */ 5398 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 5399 u8 ssid_len, mesh_id_len, mesh_id_up_len; 5400 struct cfg80211_conn *conn; 5401 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys; 5402 enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type; 5403 u32 conn_owner_nlportid; 5404 5405 struct work_struct disconnect_wk; 5406 u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5407 5408 struct list_head event_list; 5409 spinlock_t event_lock; 5410 5411 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; /* associated / joined */ 5412 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; 5413 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 5414 5415 bool ibss_fixed; 5416 bool ibss_dfs_possible; 5417 5418 bool ps; 5419 int ps_timeout; 5420 5421 int beacon_interval; 5422 5423 u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid; 5424 5425 u32 owner_nlportid; 5426 bool nl_owner_dead; 5427 5428 bool cac_started; 5429 unsigned long cac_start_time; 5430 unsigned int cac_time_ms; 5431 5432 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 5433 /* wext data */ 5434 struct { 5435 struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss; 5436 struct cfg80211_connect_params connect; 5437 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys; 5438 const u8 *ie; 5439 size_t ie_len; 5440 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5441 u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 5442 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 5443 s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key; 5444 bool prev_bssid_valid; 5445 } wext; 5446 #endif 5447 5448 struct cfg80211_cqm_config *cqm_config; 5449 5450 struct list_head pmsr_list; 5451 spinlock_t pmsr_lock; 5452 struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk; 5453 5454 unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported; 5455 }; 5456 5457 static inline u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5458 { 5459 if (wdev->netdev) 5460 return wdev->netdev->dev_addr; 5461 return wdev->address; 5462 } 5463 5464 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5465 { 5466 if (wdev->netdev) 5467 return netif_running(wdev->netdev); 5468 return wdev->is_running; 5469 } 5470 5471 /** 5472 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev 5473 * 5474 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return 5475 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev. 5476 */ 5477 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 5478 { 5479 BUG_ON(!wdev); 5480 return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy); 5481 } 5482 5483 /** 5484 * DOC: Utility functions 5485 * 5486 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful. 5487 */ 5488 5489 /** 5490 * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel 5491 * 5492 * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel 5493 * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel 5494 * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b 5495 */ 5496 static inline bool 5497 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a, 5498 struct ieee80211_channel *b) 5499 { 5500 return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq && 5501 a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset); 5502 } 5503 5504 /** 5505 * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz 5506 * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert 5507 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz) 5508 */ 5509 static inline u32 5510 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 5511 { 5512 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset; 5513 } 5514 5515 /** 5516 * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan 5517 * 5518 * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ 5519 * @chan: channel 5520 * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq 5521 */ 5522 enum nl80211_chan_width 5523 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 5524 5525 /** 5526 * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency 5527 * @chan: channel number 5528 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 5529 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 5530 */ 5531 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band); 5532 5533 /** 5534 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency 5535 * @chan: channel number 5536 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 5537 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 5538 */ 5539 static inline int 5540 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band) 5541 { 5542 return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band)); 5543 } 5544 5545 /** 5546 * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 5547 * @freq: center frequency in KHz 5548 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 5549 */ 5550 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq); 5551 5552 /** 5553 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 5554 * @freq: center frequency in MHz 5555 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 5556 */ 5557 static inline int 5558 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq) 5559 { 5560 return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 5561 } 5562 5563 /** 5564 * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified 5565 * frequency 5566 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 5567 * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel 5568 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 5569 */ 5570 struct ieee80211_channel * 5571 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq); 5572 5573 /** 5574 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency 5575 * 5576 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 5577 * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel 5578 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 5579 */ 5580 static inline struct ieee80211_channel * 5581 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq) 5582 { 5583 return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 5584 } 5585 5586 /** 5587 * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC 5588 * @chan: control channel to check 5589 * 5590 * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in 5591 * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3 5592 */ 5593 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 5594 { 5595 if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ) 5596 return false; 5597 5598 return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5; 5599 } 5600 5601 /** 5602 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate 5603 * 5604 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 5605 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates 5606 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate 5607 * 5608 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that 5609 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map, 5610 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of 5611 * rates in the band's bitrate table. 5612 */ 5613 const struct ieee80211_rate * 5614 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 5615 u32 basic_rates, int bitrate); 5616 5617 /** 5618 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band 5619 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 5620 * @scan_width: width of the control channel 5621 * 5622 * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given 5623 * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array. 5624 */ 5625 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 5626 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width); 5627 5628 /* 5629 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support 5630 * 5631 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c 5632 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst 5633 */ 5634 5635 struct radiotap_align_size { 5636 uint8_t align:4, size:4; 5637 }; 5638 5639 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace { 5640 const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size; 5641 int n_bits; 5642 uint32_t oui; 5643 uint8_t subns; 5644 }; 5645 5646 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces { 5647 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns; 5648 int n_ns; 5649 }; 5650 5651 /** 5652 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args 5653 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call 5654 * to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() 5655 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each 5656 * call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after 5657 * ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to 5658 * the beginning of the actual data portion 5659 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience 5660 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition 5661 * (or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown) 5662 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default 5663 * radiotap namespace or not 5664 * 5665 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through 5666 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering 5667 * @_arg_index: next argument index 5668 * @_arg: next argument pointer 5669 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32 5670 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present 5671 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions 5672 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data 5673 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the 5674 * next bitmap word 5675 * 5676 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore 5677 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally. 5678 */ 5679 5680 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator { 5681 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader; 5682 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns; 5683 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace; 5684 5685 unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data; 5686 __le32 *_next_bitmap; 5687 5688 unsigned char *this_arg; 5689 int this_arg_index; 5690 int this_arg_size; 5691 5692 int is_radiotap_ns; 5693 5694 int _max_length; 5695 int _arg_index; 5696 uint32_t _bitmap_shifter; 5697 int _reset_on_ext; 5698 }; 5699 5700 int 5701 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator, 5702 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header, 5703 int max_length, 5704 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns); 5705 5706 int 5707 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator); 5708 5709 5710 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6]; 5711 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6]; 5712 5713 /** 5714 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data 5715 * 5716 * @skb: the frame 5717 * 5718 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function 5719 * returns the 802.11 header length. 5720 * 5721 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption 5722 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid 5723 * 802.11 header. 5724 */ 5725 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb); 5726 5727 /** 5728 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control 5729 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format 5730 * Return: The header length in bytes. 5731 */ 5732 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc); 5733 5734 /** 5735 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length 5736 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field 5737 * (first byte) will be accessed 5738 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at 5739 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present. 5740 */ 5741 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr); 5742 5743 /** 5744 * DOC: Data path helpers 5745 * 5746 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers 5747 * functions that help implement the data path for devices 5748 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device. 5749 */ 5750 5751 /** 5752 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 5753 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 5754 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead 5755 * of it being pushed into the SKB 5756 * @addr: the device MAC address 5757 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 5758 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header 5759 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 5760 */ 5761 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr, 5762 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 5763 u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu); 5764 5765 /** 5766 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 5767 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 5768 * @addr: the device MAC address 5769 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 5770 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 5771 */ 5772 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr, 5773 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 5774 { 5775 return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false); 5776 } 5777 5778 /** 5779 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame 5780 * 5781 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames. 5782 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully 5783 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function. 5784 * 5785 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. 5786 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and 5787 * initialized by the caller. 5788 * @addr: The device MAC address. 5789 * @iftype: The device interface type. 5790 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list. 5791 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 5792 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 5793 */ 5794 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list, 5795 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 5796 const unsigned int extra_headroom, 5797 const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa); 5798 5799 /** 5800 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame 5801 * @skb: the data frame 5802 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use 5803 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag. 5804 */ 5805 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb, 5806 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 5807 5808 /** 5809 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data 5810 * 5811 * @eid: element ID 5812 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5813 * @len: length of data 5814 * @match: byte array to match 5815 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 5816 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match. 5817 * Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers 5818 * the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take 5819 * the data portion instead. 5820 * 5821 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5822 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5823 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5824 * requested element struct. 5825 * 5826 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5827 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 5828 * byte array to match. 5829 */ 5830 const struct element * 5831 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 5832 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 5833 unsigned int match_offset); 5834 5835 /** 5836 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data 5837 * 5838 * @eid: element ID 5839 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5840 * @len: length of data 5841 * @match: byte array to match 5842 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 5843 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match. 5844 * If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero. 5845 * Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first 5846 * byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and 5847 * the second byte is the IE length. 5848 * 5849 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5850 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5851 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first 5852 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 5853 * element ID. 5854 * 5855 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5856 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 5857 * byte array to match. 5858 */ 5859 static inline const u8 * 5860 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 5861 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 5862 unsigned int match_offset) 5863 { 5864 /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is 5865 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well. 5866 */ 5867 if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) || 5868 (!match_len && match_offset))) 5869 return NULL; 5870 5871 return (void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, 5872 match, match_len, 5873 match_offset ? 5874 match_offset - 2 : 0); 5875 } 5876 5877 /** 5878 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data 5879 * 5880 * @eid: element ID 5881 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5882 * @len: length of data 5883 * 5884 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5885 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5886 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5887 * requested element struct. 5888 * 5889 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5890 * having to fit into the given data. 5891 */ 5892 static inline const struct element * 5893 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5894 { 5895 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 5896 } 5897 5898 /** 5899 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data 5900 * 5901 * @eid: element ID 5902 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5903 * @len: length of data 5904 * 5905 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 5906 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5907 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 5908 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 5909 * 5910 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5911 * having to fit into the given data. 5912 */ 5913 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5914 { 5915 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 5916 } 5917 5918 /** 5919 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data 5920 * 5921 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 5922 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5923 * @len: length of data 5924 * 5925 * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if 5926 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5927 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 5928 * requested element struct. 5929 * 5930 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5931 * having to fit into the given data. 5932 */ 5933 static inline const struct element * 5934 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5935 { 5936 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 5937 &ext_eid, 1, 0); 5938 } 5939 5940 /** 5941 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data 5942 * 5943 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 5944 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5945 * @len: length of data 5946 * 5947 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if 5948 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 5949 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 5950 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 5951 * 5952 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 5953 * having to fit into the given data. 5954 */ 5955 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 5956 { 5957 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 5958 &ext_eid, 1, 2); 5959 } 5960 5961 /** 5962 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data 5963 * 5964 * @oui: vendor OUI 5965 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 5966 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5967 * @len: length of data 5968 * 5969 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 5970 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise 5971 * return the element structure for the requested element. 5972 * 5973 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 5974 * the given data. 5975 */ 5976 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 5977 const u8 *ies, 5978 unsigned int len); 5979 5980 /** 5981 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data 5982 * 5983 * @oui: vendor OUI 5984 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 5985 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 5986 * @len: length of data 5987 * 5988 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 5989 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to 5990 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 5991 * element ID. 5992 * 5993 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 5994 * the given data. 5995 */ 5996 static inline const u8 * 5997 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 5998 const u8 *ies, unsigned int len) 5999 { 6000 return (void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len); 6001 } 6002 6003 /** 6004 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame 6005 * 6006 * @dev: network device 6007 * @addr: STA MAC address 6008 * 6009 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge 6010 * devices upon STA association. 6011 */ 6012 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 6013 6014 /** 6015 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure 6016 * 6017 * TODO 6018 */ 6019 6020 /** 6021 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain 6022 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting 6023 * conflicts) 6024 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain 6025 * should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you 6026 * set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted 6027 * alpha2. 6028 * 6029 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core 6030 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by 6031 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory 6032 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain. 6033 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried 6034 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country. 6035 * 6036 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call. 6037 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(), 6038 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw(). 6039 * 6040 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 6041 * an -ENOMEM. 6042 * 6043 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM. 6044 */ 6045 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2); 6046 6047 /** 6048 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers 6049 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6050 * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy 6051 * 6052 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they 6053 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more 6054 * information. 6055 * 6056 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 6057 */ 6058 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6059 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 6060 6061 /** 6062 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers 6063 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6064 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy 6065 * 6066 * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and 6067 * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details 6068 * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(). 6069 * 6070 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 6071 */ 6072 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6073 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 6074 6075 /** 6076 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain 6077 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6078 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy 6079 * 6080 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply 6081 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory 6082 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The 6083 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous 6084 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a 6085 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled. 6086 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag 6087 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy 6088 * that called this helper. 6089 */ 6090 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6091 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd); 6092 6093 /** 6094 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency 6095 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for 6096 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for 6097 * 6098 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on 6099 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain 6100 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received 6101 * and processed already. 6102 * 6103 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule 6104 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to 6105 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return 6106 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even 6107 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band. 6108 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is 6109 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific. 6110 */ 6111 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6112 u32 center_freq); 6113 6114 /** 6115 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name 6116 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator 6117 * 6118 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a 6119 * proper string representation. 6120 */ 6121 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator); 6122 6123 /** 6124 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom 6125 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked. 6126 * 6127 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI). 6128 */ 6129 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6130 6131 /** 6132 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions 6133 * 6134 */ 6135 6136 /** 6137 * reg_query_regdb_wmm - Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule 6138 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively 6139 * 6140 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried. 6141 * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried. 6142 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db. 6143 * 6144 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to query 6145 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given 6146 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations. 6147 * 6148 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 6149 * an -ENODATA. 6150 * 6151 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA. 6152 */ 6153 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq, 6154 struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule); 6155 6156 /* 6157 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification 6158 * functions and BSS handling helpers 6159 */ 6160 6161 /** 6162 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished 6163 * 6164 * @request: the corresponding scan request 6165 * @info: information about the completed scan 6166 */ 6167 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request, 6168 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); 6169 6170 /** 6171 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available 6172 * 6173 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results 6174 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6175 */ 6176 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6177 6178 /** 6179 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 6180 * 6181 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 6182 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6183 * 6184 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 6185 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 6186 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 6187 */ 6188 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6189 6190 /** 6191 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 6192 * 6193 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 6194 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6195 * 6196 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 6197 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 6198 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 6199 * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held. 6200 */ 6201 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6202 6203 /** 6204 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame 6205 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 6206 * @data: the BSS metadata 6207 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon) 6208 * @len: length of the management frame 6209 * @gfp: context flags 6210 * 6211 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 6212 * the BSS should be updated/added. 6213 * 6214 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 6215 * Or %NULL on error. 6216 */ 6217 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6218 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6219 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 6220 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6221 gfp_t gfp); 6222 6223 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6224 cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6225 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6226 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width, 6227 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6228 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6229 { 6230 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6231 .chan = rx_channel, 6232 .scan_width = scan_width, 6233 .signal = signal, 6234 }; 6235 6236 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); 6237 } 6238 6239 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6240 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6241 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6242 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 6243 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6244 { 6245 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6246 .chan = rx_channel, 6247 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 6248 .signal = signal, 6249 }; 6250 6251 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); 6252 } 6253 6254 /** 6255 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID 6256 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID 6257 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element 6258 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element 6259 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID 6260 */ 6261 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid, 6262 u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid) 6263 { 6264 u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid); 6265 u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0); 6266 u64 new_bssid_u64; 6267 6268 new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask; 6269 6270 new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask; 6271 6272 u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid); 6273 } 6274 6275 /** 6276 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited 6277 * @element: element to check 6278 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element 6279 */ 6280 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element, 6281 const struct element *non_inherit_element); 6282 6283 /** 6284 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs 6285 * @ie: ies 6286 * @ielen: length of IEs 6287 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element 6288 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile) 6289 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile 6290 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length 6291 */ 6292 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6293 const struct element *mbssid_elem, 6294 const struct element *sub_elem, 6295 u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len); 6296 6297 /** 6298 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from 6299 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is 6300 * from a beacon or probe response 6301 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon 6302 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response 6303 */ 6304 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type { 6305 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN, 6306 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON, 6307 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP, 6308 }; 6309 6310 /** 6311 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS 6312 * 6313 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 6314 * @data: the BSS metadata 6315 * @ftype: frame type (if known) 6316 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS 6317 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0) 6318 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer 6319 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer 6320 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer 6321 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs 6322 * @gfp: context flags 6323 * 6324 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 6325 * the BSS should be updated/added. 6326 * 6327 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 6328 * Or %NULL on error. 6329 */ 6330 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6331 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6332 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 6333 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6334 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6335 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6336 gfp_t gfp); 6337 6338 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6339 cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6340 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6341 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width, 6342 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6343 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6344 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6345 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6346 { 6347 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6348 .chan = rx_channel, 6349 .scan_width = scan_width, 6350 .signal = signal, 6351 }; 6352 6353 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, 6354 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, 6355 gfp); 6356 } 6357 6358 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 6359 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6360 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 6361 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 6362 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 6363 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 6364 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 6365 { 6366 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 6367 .chan = rx_channel, 6368 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20, 6369 .signal = signal, 6370 }; 6371 6372 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, 6373 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, 6374 gfp); 6375 } 6376 6377 /** 6378 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference 6379 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6380 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL) 6381 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL) 6382 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL) 6383 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0) 6384 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type 6385 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy 6386 */ 6387 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6388 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 6389 const u8 *bssid, 6390 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 6391 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type, 6392 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy); 6393 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * 6394 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6395 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 6396 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len) 6397 { 6398 return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len, 6399 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 6400 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY); 6401 } 6402 6403 /** 6404 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct 6405 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6406 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference 6407 * 6408 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct. 6409 */ 6410 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6411 6412 /** 6413 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct 6414 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 6415 * @bss: the BSS struct 6416 * 6417 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct. 6418 */ 6419 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6420 6421 /** 6422 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures 6423 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6424 * @bss: the bss to remove 6425 * 6426 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures 6427 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this 6428 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time 6429 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all. 6430 */ 6431 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6432 6433 /** 6434 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries 6435 * 6436 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy 6437 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not 6438 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB. 6439 * 6440 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6441 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel 6442 * of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel. 6443 * @iter: the iterator function to call 6444 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function 6445 */ 6446 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6447 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 6448 void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6449 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 6450 void *data), 6451 void *iter_data); 6452 6453 static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width 6454 cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 6455 { 6456 switch (chandef->width) { 6457 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 6458 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5; 6459 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 6460 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10; 6461 default: 6462 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20; 6463 } 6464 } 6465 6466 /** 6467 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame 6468 * @dev: network device 6469 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body) 6470 * @len: length of the frame data 6471 * 6472 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or 6473 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode. 6474 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must 6475 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6476 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 6477 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6478 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed 6479 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used 6480 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function 6481 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead. 6482 * 6483 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6484 */ 6485 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 6486 6487 /** 6488 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication 6489 * @dev: network device 6490 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out 6491 * 6492 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's 6493 * mutex. 6494 */ 6495 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 6496 6497 /** 6498 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response 6499 * @dev: network device 6500 * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer 6501 * moves to cfg80211 in this call 6502 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body) 6503 * @len: length of the frame data 6504 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format 6505 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 6506 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame 6507 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data 6508 * 6509 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 6510 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 6511 * 6512 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6513 */ 6514 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev, 6515 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 6516 const u8 *buf, size_t len, 6517 int uapsd_queues, 6518 const u8 *req_ies, size_t req_ies_len); 6519 6520 /** 6521 * cfg80211_assoc_timeout - notification of timed out association 6522 * @dev: network device 6523 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association timed out. 6524 * 6525 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6526 */ 6527 void cfg80211_assoc_timeout(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6528 6529 /** 6530 * cfg80211_abandon_assoc - notify cfg80211 of abandoned association attempt 6531 * @dev: network device 6532 * @bss: The BSS entry with which association was abandoned. 6533 * 6534 * Call this whenever - for reasons reported through other API, like deauth RX, 6535 * an association attempt was abandoned. 6536 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 6537 */ 6538 void cfg80211_abandon_assoc(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 6539 6540 /** 6541 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame 6542 * @dev: network device 6543 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body) 6544 * @len: length of the frame data 6545 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute) 6546 * 6547 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in 6548 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and 6549 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the 6550 * corresponding wdev's mutex. 6551 */ 6552 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 6553 bool reconnect); 6554 6555 /** 6556 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame 6557 * @dev: network device 6558 * @buf: received management frame (header + body) 6559 * @len: length of the frame data 6560 * 6561 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc 6562 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the 6563 * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon 6564 * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while 6565 * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode). 6566 * 6567 * This function may sleep. 6568 */ 6569 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, 6570 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 6571 6572 /** 6573 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP) 6574 * @dev: network device 6575 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame 6576 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used 6577 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing. 6578 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets) 6579 * @gfp: allocation flags 6580 * 6581 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a 6582 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() 6583 * primitive. 6584 */ 6585 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 6586 enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id, 6587 const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp); 6588 6589 /** 6590 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS 6591 * 6592 * @dev: network device 6593 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined 6594 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined 6595 * @gfp: allocation flags 6596 * 6597 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or 6598 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called, 6599 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of 6600 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called 6601 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is 6602 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest. 6603 */ 6604 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 6605 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp); 6606 6607 /** 6608 * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer 6609 * candidate 6610 * 6611 * @dev: network device 6612 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate 6613 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate 6614 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer 6615 * @gfp: allocation flags 6616 * 6617 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been 6618 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response. 6619 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace. 6620 */ 6621 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev, 6622 const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len, 6623 int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp); 6624 6625 /** 6626 * DOC: RFkill integration 6627 * 6628 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers, 6629 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each 6630 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated 6631 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are 6632 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down. 6633 * 6634 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they 6635 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211. 6636 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here. 6637 */ 6638 6639 /** 6640 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state 6641 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6642 * @blocked: block status 6643 * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons 6644 */ 6645 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked, 6646 enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason); 6647 6648 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked) 6649 { 6650 wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked, 6651 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL); 6652 } 6653 6654 /** 6655 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill 6656 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6657 */ 6658 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6659 6660 /** 6661 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill 6662 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6663 */ 6664 void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6665 6666 /** 6667 * DOC: Vendor commands 6668 * 6669 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that 6670 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the 6671 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with 6672 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as 6673 * the configuration mechanism. 6674 * 6675 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array 6676 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an 6677 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it. 6678 * 6679 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol 6680 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular, 6681 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any 6682 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection 6683 * managers etc. need. 6684 */ 6685 6686 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6687 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 6688 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 6689 int approxlen); 6690 6691 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6692 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6693 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 6694 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 6695 unsigned int portid, 6696 int vendor_event_idx, 6697 int approxlen, gfp_t gfp); 6698 6699 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp); 6700 6701 /** 6702 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply 6703 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6704 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6705 * be put into the skb 6706 * 6707 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 6708 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 6709 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid. 6710 * 6711 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in 6712 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 6713 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 6714 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 6715 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 6716 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute. 6717 * You must not modify the skb in any other way. 6718 * 6719 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return 6720 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation. 6721 * 6722 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6723 */ 6724 static inline struct sk_buff * 6725 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 6726 { 6727 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6728 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen); 6729 } 6730 6731 /** 6732 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb 6733 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6734 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb() 6735 * 6736 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 6737 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should 6738 * return the error code. Note that this function consumes the 6739 * skb regardless of the return value. 6740 * 6741 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 6742 */ 6743 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb); 6744 6745 /** 6746 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID 6747 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6748 * 6749 * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler. 6750 * Valid to call only there. 6751 */ 6752 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6753 6754 /** 6755 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb 6756 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6757 * @wdev: the wireless device 6758 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 6759 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6760 * be put into the skb 6761 * @gfp: allocation flags 6762 * 6763 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 6764 * vendor-specific multicast group. 6765 * 6766 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 6767 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 6768 * attribute. 6769 * 6770 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 6771 * skb to send the event. 6772 * 6773 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6774 */ 6775 static inline struct sk_buff * 6776 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6777 int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 6778 { 6779 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6780 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 6781 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 6782 } 6783 6784 /** 6785 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb 6786 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6787 * @wdev: the wireless device 6788 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 6789 * @portid: port ID of the receiver 6790 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6791 * be put into the skb 6792 * @gfp: allocation flags 6793 * 6794 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to 6795 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been 6796 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take 6797 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes. 6798 * 6799 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 6800 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 6801 * attribute. 6802 * 6803 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 6804 * skb to send the event. 6805 * 6806 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6807 */ 6808 static inline struct sk_buff * 6809 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6810 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6811 unsigned int portid, int approxlen, 6812 int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 6813 { 6814 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 6815 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 6816 portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 6817 } 6818 6819 /** 6820 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event 6821 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc() 6822 * @gfp: allocation flags 6823 * 6824 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 6825 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it. 6826 */ 6827 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 6828 { 6829 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 6830 } 6831 6832 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 6833 /** 6834 * DOC: Test mode 6835 * 6836 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to 6837 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance, 6838 * factory programming. 6839 * 6840 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more 6841 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it. 6842 */ 6843 6844 /** 6845 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply 6846 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6847 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6848 * be put into the skb 6849 * 6850 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 6851 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 6852 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid. 6853 * 6854 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in 6855 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 6856 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 6857 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 6858 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 6859 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You 6860 * must not modify the skb in any other way. 6861 * 6862 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return 6863 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation. 6864 * 6865 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6866 */ 6867 static inline struct sk_buff * 6868 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 6869 { 6870 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 6871 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen); 6872 } 6873 6874 /** 6875 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb 6876 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6877 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() 6878 * 6879 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 6880 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return 6881 * the error code. Note that this function consumes the skb 6882 * regardless of the return value. 6883 * 6884 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 6885 */ 6886 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb) 6887 { 6888 return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb); 6889 } 6890 6891 /** 6892 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event 6893 * @wiphy: the wiphy 6894 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 6895 * be put into the skb 6896 * @gfp: allocation flags 6897 * 6898 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 6899 * testmode multicast group. 6900 * 6901 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with 6902 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As 6903 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the 6904 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb 6905 * in any other way. 6906 * 6907 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the 6908 * skb to send the event. 6909 * 6910 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 6911 */ 6912 static inline struct sk_buff * 6913 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp) 6914 { 6915 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 6916 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1, 6917 approxlen, gfp); 6918 } 6919 6920 /** 6921 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event 6922 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 6923 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb() 6924 * @gfp: allocation flags 6925 * 6926 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 6927 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always 6928 * consumes it. 6929 */ 6930 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 6931 { 6932 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 6933 } 6934 6935 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) .testmode_cmd = (cmd), 6936 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) .testmode_dump = (cmd), 6937 #else 6938 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) 6939 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) 6940 #endif 6941 6942 /** 6943 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params 6944 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL) 6945 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets 6946 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in 6947 * @erp_next_seq_num is valid. 6948 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in 6949 * FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the 6950 * status for a FILS connection. 6951 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL). 6952 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets 6953 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID 6954 * used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL). 6955 */ 6956 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params { 6957 const u8 *kek; 6958 size_t kek_len; 6959 bool update_erp_next_seq_num; 6960 u16 erp_next_seq_num; 6961 const u8 *pmk; 6962 size_t pmk_len; 6963 const u8 *pmkid; 6964 }; 6965 6966 /** 6967 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params 6968 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 6969 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 6970 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 6971 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 6972 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 6973 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 6974 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 6975 * case. 6976 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL) 6977 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through 6978 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the 6979 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return 6980 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the 6981 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. 6982 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. 6983 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL) 6984 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length 6985 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL) 6986 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length 6987 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters. 6988 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 6989 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 6990 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 6991 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 6992 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 6993 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 6994 */ 6995 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params { 6996 int status; 6997 const u8 *bssid; 6998 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 6999 const u8 *req_ie; 7000 size_t req_ie_len; 7001 const u8 *resp_ie; 7002 size_t resp_ie_len; 7003 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 7004 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason; 7005 }; 7006 7007 /** 7008 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result 7009 * 7010 * @dev: network device 7011 * @params: connection response parameters 7012 * @gfp: allocation flags 7013 * 7014 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 7015 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 7016 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response 7017 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), 7018 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(), 7019 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7020 */ 7021 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev, 7022 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params, 7023 gfp_t gfp); 7024 7025 /** 7026 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result 7027 * 7028 * @dev: network device 7029 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7030 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through 7031 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the 7032 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return 7033 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the 7034 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. 7035 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. 7036 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7037 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7038 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7039 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7040 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 7041 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 7042 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 7043 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 7044 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 7045 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 7046 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 7047 * case. 7048 * @gfp: allocation flags 7049 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 7050 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 7051 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 7052 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 7053 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 7054 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 7055 * 7056 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 7057 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 7058 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss 7059 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among 7060 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 7061 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7062 */ 7063 static inline void 7064 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7065 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie, 7066 size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie, 7067 size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp, 7068 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 7069 { 7070 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params; 7071 7072 memset(¶ms, 0, sizeof(params)); 7073 params.status = status; 7074 params.bssid = bssid; 7075 params.bss = bss; 7076 params.req_ie = req_ie; 7077 params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len; 7078 params.resp_ie = resp_ie; 7079 params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len; 7080 params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason; 7081 7082 cfg80211_connect_done(dev, ¶ms, gfp); 7083 } 7084 7085 /** 7086 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result 7087 * 7088 * @dev: network device 7089 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7090 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7091 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7092 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7093 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7094 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 7095 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 7096 * the real status code for failures. 7097 * @gfp: allocation flags 7098 * 7099 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 7100 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 7101 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only 7102 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 7103 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7104 */ 7105 static inline void 7106 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7107 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, 7108 const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len, 7109 u16 status, gfp_t gfp) 7110 { 7111 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie, 7112 resp_ie_len, status, gfp, 7113 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED); 7114 } 7115 7116 /** 7117 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout 7118 * 7119 * @dev: network device 7120 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7121 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7122 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7123 * @gfp: allocation flags 7124 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. 7125 * 7126 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed 7127 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was 7128 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send 7129 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while 7130 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among 7131 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 7132 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7133 */ 7134 static inline void 7135 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7136 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp, 7137 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 7138 { 7139 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1, 7140 gfp, timeout_reason); 7141 } 7142 7143 /** 7144 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information 7145 * 7146 * @channel: the channel of the new AP 7147 * @bss: entry of bss to which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %bssid is set) 7148 * @bssid: the BSSID of the new AP (may be %NULL if %bss is set) 7149 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7150 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7151 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7152 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7153 * @fils: FILS related roaming information. 7154 */ 7155 struct cfg80211_roam_info { 7156 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 7157 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 7158 const u8 *bssid; 7159 const u8 *req_ie; 7160 size_t req_ie_len; 7161 const u8 *resp_ie; 7162 size_t resp_ie_len; 7163 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 7164 }; 7165 7166 /** 7167 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming 7168 * 7169 * @dev: network device 7170 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info. 7171 * @gfp: allocation flags 7172 * 7173 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the 7174 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry. 7175 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP 7176 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in 7177 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where 7178 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the 7179 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling 7180 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released 7181 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be 7182 * released while disconnecting from the current bss. 7183 */ 7184 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info, 7185 gfp_t gfp); 7186 7187 /** 7188 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association 7189 * 7190 * @dev: network device 7191 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7192 * @gfp: allocation flags 7193 * 7194 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake 7195 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e., 7196 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function 7197 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(), 7198 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to 7199 * indicate the 802.11 association. 7200 */ 7201 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7202 gfp_t gfp); 7203 7204 /** 7205 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped 7206 * 7207 * @dev: network device 7208 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL) 7209 * @ie_len: length of IEs 7210 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown 7211 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally 7212 * @gfp: allocation flags 7213 * 7214 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state 7215 * and not try to connect to any AP any more. 7216 */ 7217 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason, 7218 const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len, 7219 bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp); 7220 7221 /** 7222 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start 7223 * @wdev: wireless device 7224 * @cookie: the request cookie 7225 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 7226 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the 7227 * channel 7228 * @gfp: allocation flags 7229 */ 7230 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7231 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 7232 unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp); 7233 7234 /** 7235 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired 7236 * @wdev: wireless device 7237 * @cookie: the request cookie 7238 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 7239 * @gfp: allocation flags 7240 */ 7241 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7242 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 7243 gfp_t gfp); 7244 7245 /** 7246 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired 7247 * @wdev: wireless device 7248 * @cookie: the requested cookie 7249 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request) 7250 * @gfp: allocation flags 7251 */ 7252 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7253 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp); 7254 7255 /** 7256 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics. 7257 * 7258 * @sinfo: the station information 7259 * @gfp: allocation flags 7260 */ 7261 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7262 7263 /** 7264 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info 7265 * @sinfo: the station information 7266 * 7267 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station 7268 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on 7269 * the stack.) 7270 */ 7271 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo) 7272 { 7273 kfree(sinfo->pertid); 7274 } 7275 7276 /** 7277 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station 7278 * 7279 * @dev: the netdev 7280 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7281 * @sinfo: the station information 7282 * @gfp: allocation flags 7283 */ 7284 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7285 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7286 7287 /** 7288 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station 7289 * @dev: the netdev 7290 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7291 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics 7292 * @gfp: allocation flags 7293 */ 7294 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7295 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 7296 7297 /** 7298 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station 7299 * 7300 * @dev: the netdev 7301 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7302 * @gfp: allocation flags 7303 */ 7304 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev, 7305 const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp) 7306 { 7307 cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp); 7308 } 7309 7310 /** 7311 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification 7312 * 7313 * @dev: the netdev 7314 * @mac_addr: the station's address 7315 * @reason: the reason for connection failure 7316 * @gfp: allocation flags 7317 * 7318 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station 7319 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection 7320 * for some reasons, this function is called. 7321 * 7322 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from 7323 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum 7324 */ 7325 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 7326 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason, 7327 gfp_t gfp); 7328 7329 /** 7330 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 7331 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7332 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz 7333 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7334 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7335 * @len: length of the frame data 7336 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 7337 * 7338 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 7339 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 7340 * 7341 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 7342 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 7343 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 7344 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 7345 */ 7346 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, int sig_dbm, 7347 const u8 *buf, size_t len, u32 flags); 7348 7349 /** 7350 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 7351 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7352 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz 7353 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7354 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7355 * @len: length of the frame data 7356 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 7357 * 7358 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 7359 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 7360 * 7361 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 7362 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 7363 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 7364 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 7365 */ 7366 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, 7367 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 7368 u32 flags) 7369 { 7370 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(wdev, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), sig_dbm, buf, len, 7371 flags); 7372 } 7373 7374 /** 7375 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame 7376 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7377 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() 7378 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 7379 * @len: length of the frame data 7380 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 7381 * @gfp: context flags 7382 * 7383 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be 7384 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the 7385 * transmission attempt. 7386 */ 7387 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7388 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp); 7389 7390 /** 7391 * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control 7392 * port frames 7393 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 7394 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() 7395 * @buf: Data frame (header + body) 7396 * @len: length of the frame data 7397 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 7398 * @gfp: context flags 7399 * 7400 * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be 7401 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of 7402 * the transmission attempt. 7403 */ 7404 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 7405 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, 7406 gfp_t gfp); 7407 7408 /** 7409 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame 7410 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7411 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame. It is assumed that the skbuf 7412 * is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header). The skb can be non-linear. 7413 * This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is 7414 * responsible for any cleanup. The caller must also ensure that 7415 * skb->protocol is set appropriately. 7416 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted 7417 * 7418 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port 7419 * frame. It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive 7420 * control port frames over nl80211. 7421 * 7422 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all 7423 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame). 7424 * 7425 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace 7426 */ 7427 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, 7428 struct sk_buff *skb, bool unencrypted); 7429 7430 /** 7431 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event 7432 * @dev: network device 7433 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event 7434 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available 7435 * @gfp: context flags 7436 * 7437 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring 7438 * rssi threshold reached event occurs. 7439 */ 7440 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7441 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, 7442 s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp); 7443 7444 /** 7445 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer 7446 * @dev: network device 7447 * @peer: peer's MAC address 7448 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold 7449 * but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent 7450 * threshold (to account for temporary interference) 7451 * @gfp: context flags 7452 */ 7453 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7454 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp); 7455 7456 /** 7457 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event 7458 * @dev: network device 7459 * @peer: peer's MAC address 7460 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost 7461 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission 7462 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached. 7463 * @gfp: context flags 7464 * 7465 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a 7466 * given interval is exceeded. 7467 */ 7468 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 7469 u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp); 7470 7471 /** 7472 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event 7473 * @dev: network device 7474 * @gfp: context flags 7475 * 7476 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP. 7477 */ 7478 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp); 7479 7480 /** 7481 * cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event 7482 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7483 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 7484 * @gfp: context flags 7485 * 7486 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl. 7487 */ 7488 void cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7489 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, gfp_t gfp); 7490 7491 /** 7492 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event 7493 * @dev: network device 7494 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified 7495 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value 7496 * @gfp: context flags 7497 * 7498 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action 7499 * frame. 7500 */ 7501 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac, 7502 struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode, 7503 gfp_t gfp); 7504 7505 /** 7506 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event 7507 * @netdev: network device 7508 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 7509 * @event: type of event 7510 * @gfp: context flags 7511 * 7512 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished 7513 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process, 7514 * also by full-MAC drivers. 7515 */ 7516 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev, 7517 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7518 enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp); 7519 7520 7521 /** 7522 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying 7523 * @dev: network device 7524 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races) 7525 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter 7526 * @gfp: allocation flags 7527 */ 7528 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7529 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); 7530 7531 /** 7532 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate 7533 * @dev: network device 7534 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority) 7535 * @bssid: BSSID of AP 7536 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication 7537 * @gfp: allocation flags 7538 */ 7539 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index, 7540 const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp); 7541 7542 /** 7543 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame 7544 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7545 * @addr: the transmitter address 7546 * @gfp: context flags 7547 * 7548 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 7549 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the 7550 * sender. 7551 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 7552 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 7553 */ 7554 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev, 7555 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 7556 7557 /** 7558 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame 7559 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 7560 * @addr: the transmitter address 7561 * @gfp: context flags 7562 * 7563 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 7564 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected. 7565 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each 7566 * station to avoid event flooding. 7567 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 7568 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 7569 */ 7570 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev, 7571 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 7572 7573 /** 7574 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status 7575 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on 7576 * @addr: the address of the peer 7577 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously 7578 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not 7579 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame. 7580 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not. 7581 * @gfp: allocation flags 7582 */ 7583 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 7584 u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal, 7585 bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp); 7586 7587 /** 7588 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs 7589 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 7590 * @frame: the frame 7591 * @len: length of the frame 7592 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz 7593 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7594 * 7595 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 7596 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 7597 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 7598 */ 7599 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame, 7600 size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm); 7601 7602 /** 7603 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs 7604 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 7605 * @frame: the frame 7606 * @len: length of the frame 7607 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on 7608 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 7609 * 7610 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 7611 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 7612 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 7613 */ 7614 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7615 const u8 *frame, size_t len, 7616 int freq, int sig_dbm) 7617 { 7618 cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), 7619 sig_dbm); 7620 } 7621 7622 /** 7623 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed 7624 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7625 * @chandef: the channel definition 7626 * @iftype: interface type 7627 * 7628 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 7629 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.) 7630 */ 7631 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7632 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7633 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 7634 7635 /** 7636 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation 7637 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7638 * @chandef: the channel definition 7639 * @iftype: interface type 7640 * 7641 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 7642 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version 7643 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under 7644 * more permissive conditions. 7645 * 7646 * Requires the wiphy mutex to be held. 7647 */ 7648 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7649 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7650 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 7651 7652 /* 7653 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace 7654 * @dev: the device which switched channels 7655 * @chandef: the new channel definition 7656 * 7657 * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable 7658 * driver context! 7659 */ 7660 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7661 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 7662 7663 /* 7664 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start 7665 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started 7666 * @chandef: the future channel definition 7667 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens 7668 * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP 7669 * 7670 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just 7671 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting 7672 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary. 7673 */ 7674 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, 7675 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7676 u8 count, bool quiet); 7677 7678 /** 7679 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band 7680 * 7681 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert 7682 * @band: band pointer to fill 7683 * 7684 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 7685 */ 7686 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class, 7687 enum nl80211_band *band); 7688 7689 /** 7690 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class 7691 * 7692 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 7693 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class 7694 * 7695 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 7696 */ 7697 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7698 u8 *op_class); 7699 7700 /** 7701 * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz 7702 * 7703 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 7704 * 7705 * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz. 7706 */ 7707 static inline u32 7708 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 7709 { 7710 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset; 7711 } 7712 7713 /* 7714 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation 7715 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested 7716 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device 7717 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or 7718 * NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN) 7719 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request 7720 * @gfp: allocation flags 7721 * 7722 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that 7723 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP 7724 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use 7725 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g., 7726 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer). 7727 */ 7728 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 7729 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, 7730 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); 7731 7732 /* 7733 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units) 7734 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from 7735 * 7736 * return 0 if MCS index >= 32 7737 */ 7738 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate); 7739 7740 /** 7741 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev 7742 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove 7743 * 7744 * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary 7745 * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device 7746 * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called 7747 * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device 7748 * is unbound from the driver. 7749 * 7750 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 7751 */ 7752 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 7753 7754 /** 7755 * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev 7756 * @dev: the netdev to register 7757 * 7758 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather 7759 * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is 7760 * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable 7761 * instead as well. 7762 * 7763 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 7764 */ 7765 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev); 7766 7767 /** 7768 * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev 7769 * @dev: the netdev to register 7770 * 7771 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather 7772 * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL 7773 * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are 7774 * usable instead as well. 7775 * 7776 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 7777 */ 7778 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev) 7779 { 7780 cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr); 7781 } 7782 7783 /** 7784 * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements 7785 * @ies: FT IEs 7786 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes 7787 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address 7788 * @ric_ies: RIC IE 7789 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes 7790 */ 7791 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params { 7792 const u8 *ies; 7793 size_t ies_len; 7794 const u8 *target_ap; 7795 const u8 *ric_ies; 7796 size_t ric_ies_len; 7797 }; 7798 7799 /** 7800 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE 7801 * @netdev: network device 7802 * @ft_event: IE information 7803 */ 7804 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev, 7805 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event); 7806 7807 /** 7808 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer 7809 * @ies: the input IE buffer 7810 * @len: the input length 7811 * @attr: the attribute ID to find 7812 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g. 7813 * if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size 7814 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer 7815 * 7816 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and 7817 * copies its contents to the given buffer. 7818 * 7819 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is 7820 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the 7821 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero). 7822 */ 7823 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 7824 enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr, 7825 u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize); 7826 7827 /** 7828 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC) 7829 * @ies: the IE buffer 7830 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 7831 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 7832 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 7833 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 7834 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 7835 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element 7836 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array 7837 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 7838 * 7839 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 7840 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 7841 * split. 7842 * 7843 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 7844 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 7845 * 7846 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 7847 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 7848 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 7849 * 7850 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 7851 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 7852 * of the buffer should be used. 7853 */ 7854 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 7855 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, 7856 const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric, 7857 size_t offset); 7858 7859 /** 7860 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering 7861 * @ies: the IE buffer 7862 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 7863 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 7864 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 7865 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 7866 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 7867 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 7868 * 7869 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 7870 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 7871 * split. 7872 * 7873 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 7874 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 7875 * 7876 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 7877 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 7878 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 7879 * 7880 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 7881 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 7882 * of the buffer should be used. 7883 */ 7884 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 7885 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset) 7886 { 7887 return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset); 7888 } 7889 7890 /** 7891 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN 7892 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup 7893 * @wakeup: the wakeup report 7894 * @gfp: allocation flags 7895 * 7896 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it 7897 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may 7898 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something 7899 * else caused the wakeup. 7900 */ 7901 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7902 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, 7903 gfp_t gfp); 7904 7905 /** 7906 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver. 7907 * 7908 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped. 7909 * @gfp: allocation flags 7910 * 7911 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted 7912 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given 7913 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired. 7914 */ 7915 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp); 7916 7917 /** 7918 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has 7919 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7920 * 7921 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device. 7922 */ 7923 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7924 7925 /** 7926 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations 7927 * 7928 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7929 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 7930 * 7931 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a 7932 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to 7933 * the interface combinations. 7934 */ 7935 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7936 struct iface_combination_params *params); 7937 7938 /** 7939 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations 7940 * 7941 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7942 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 7943 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination 7944 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function 7945 * 7946 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible 7947 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching 7948 * purposes. 7949 */ 7950 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7951 struct iface_combination_params *params, 7952 void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c, 7953 void *data), 7954 void *data); 7955 7956 /* 7957 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection 7958 * 7959 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7960 * @wdev: wireless device 7961 * @gfp: context flags 7962 * 7963 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA 7964 * disconnected. 7965 * 7966 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous. 7967 */ 7968 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7969 gfp_t gfp); 7970 7971 /** 7972 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy 7973 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down 7974 * 7975 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by 7976 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed). 7977 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors 7978 * that really can't be recovered in any other way. 7979 * 7980 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into 7981 * the driver while the function is running. 7982 */ 7983 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7984 7985 /** 7986 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag 7987 * 7988 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 7989 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 7990 * 7991 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 7992 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 7993 */ 7994 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7995 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 7996 { 7997 u8 *ft_byte; 7998 7999 ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 8000 *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8); 8001 } 8002 8003 /** 8004 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag 8005 * 8006 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 8007 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 8008 * 8009 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 8010 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 8011 */ 8012 static inline bool 8013 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8014 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 8015 { 8016 u8 ft_byte; 8017 8018 ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 8019 return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0; 8020 } 8021 8022 /** 8023 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function 8024 * @f: NAN function that should be freed 8025 * 8026 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members. 8027 */ 8028 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f); 8029 8030 /** 8031 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters 8032 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is 8033 * %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber. 8034 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery 8035 * result. 8036 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up. 8037 * @inst_id: the local instance id 8038 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function 8039 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer 8040 * @info_len: the length of the &info 8041 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any) 8042 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function 8043 */ 8044 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params { 8045 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 8046 u8 inst_id; 8047 u8 peer_inst_id; 8048 const u8 *addr; 8049 u8 info_len; 8050 const u8 *info; 8051 u64 cookie; 8052 }; 8053 8054 /** 8055 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function. 8056 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 8057 * @match: match notification parameters 8058 * @gfp: allocation flags 8059 * 8060 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This 8061 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that 8062 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received. 8063 */ 8064 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8065 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp); 8066 8067 /** 8068 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. 8069 * 8070 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 8071 * @inst_id: the local instance id 8072 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) 8073 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier 8074 * @gfp: allocation flags 8075 * 8076 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated. 8077 */ 8078 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8079 u8 inst_id, 8080 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, 8081 u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp); 8082 8083 /* ethtool helper */ 8084 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info); 8085 8086 /** 8087 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication 8088 * @netdev: network device 8089 * @params: External authentication parameters 8090 * @gfp: allocation flags 8091 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error 8092 */ 8093 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev, 8094 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params, 8095 gfp_t gfp); 8096 8097 /** 8098 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data 8099 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 8100 * @req: the original measurement request 8101 * @result: the result data 8102 * @gfp: allocation flags 8103 */ 8104 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8105 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 8106 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result, 8107 gfp_t gfp); 8108 8109 /** 8110 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed 8111 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 8112 * @req: the original measurement request 8113 * @gfp: allocation flags 8114 * 8115 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this 8116 * the request pointer will no longer be valid. 8117 */ 8118 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8119 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 8120 gfp_t gfp); 8121 8122 /** 8123 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed 8124 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8125 * @iftype: interface type 8126 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1' 8127 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces 8128 * 8129 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API 8130 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when 8131 * check_swif is '1'. 8132 */ 8133 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 8134 bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif); 8135 8136 8137 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */ 8138 8139 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */ 8140 8141 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...) \ 8142 dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8143 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8144 dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8145 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8146 dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8147 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8148 dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8149 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8150 dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8151 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8152 dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8153 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8154 dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8155 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8156 dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8157 8158 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8159 dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8160 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8161 dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8162 8163 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8164 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args) 8165 8166 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8167 dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 8168 8169 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG) 8170 #define wiphy_vdbg wiphy_dbg 8171 #else 8172 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8173 ({ \ 8174 if (0) \ 8175 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args); \ 8176 0; \ 8177 }) 8178 #endif 8179 8180 /* 8181 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference 8182 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the 8183 * file/line information and a backtrace. 8184 */ 8185 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...) \ 8186 WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args); 8187 8188 /** 8189 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space 8190 * @netdev: network device 8191 * @owe_info: peer's owe info 8192 * @gfp: allocation flags 8193 */ 8194 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev, 8195 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info, 8196 gfp_t gfp); 8197 8198 /** 8199 * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries 8200 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8201 */ 8202 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy); 8203 8204 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */ 8205